blob: 4fee7066d5d2fa249b0657c3d4f42f8e28b3e8b0 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denkeca3aeb2013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +020038who contributed the specific port. The boards.cfg file lists board
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010039maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000040
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000041Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
42it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
43
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
51U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
61The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
62git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
110
111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000113
114
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900135 /arc Files generic to ARC architecture
136 /cpu CPU specific files
137 /arc700 Files specific to ARC 700 CPUs
138 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500139 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
140 /cpu CPU specific files
141 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
142 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000143 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200144 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
145 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
147 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500148 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500149 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
150 /lib Architecture specific library files
151 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /lib Architecture specific library files
154 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
155 /cpu CPU specific files
156 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500157 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
158 /cpu CPU specific files
159 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
160 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
161 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
162 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
163 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
164 /lib Architecture specific library files
165 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
166 /cpu CPU specific files
167 /lib Architecture specific library files
168 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
169 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200170 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Masahiro Yamada6eae68e2014-03-07 18:02:02 +0900171 /mips64 Files specific to MIPS64 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500172 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000173 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
174 /cpu CPU specific files
175 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
176 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500177 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
178 /cpu CPU specific files
179 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400180 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
181 /cpu CPU specific files
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200183 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500184 /cpu CPU specific files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500185 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
186 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
187 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500188 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
189 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
190 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
191 /lib Architecture specific library files
192 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
193 /cpu CPU specific files
194 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
195 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
196 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
197 /lib Architecture specific library files
198 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
199 /cpu CPU specific files
200 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
201 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
202 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400203 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
204 /cpu CPU specific files
205 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500206/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
207/board Board dependent files
208/common Misc architecture independent functions
209/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
210/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
211/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400212/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500213/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
214/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
215/include Header Files
216/lib Files generic to all architectures
217 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
218 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
219 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
220/net Networking code
221/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Day33c77312013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400222/spl Secondary Program Loader framework
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500223/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000224
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000225Software Configuration:
226=======================
227
228Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
229rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
230
231There are two classes of configuration variables:
232
233* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
234 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
235 "CONFIG_".
236
237* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
238 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
239 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200240 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000241
242Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
243identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
244do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
245links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
246as an example here.
247
248
249Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
250---------------------------------------------------
251
252For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200253configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_defconfig".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000254
255Example: For a TQM823L module type:
256
257 cd u-boot
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200258 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000259
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200260For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +0200261e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_defconfig". And also configure the cogent
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000262directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
263
264
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600265Sandbox Environment:
266--------------------
267
268U-Boot can be built natively to run on a Linux host using the 'sandbox'
269board. This allows feature development which is not board- or architecture-
270specific to be undertaken on a native platform. The sandbox is also used to
271run some of U-Boot's tests.
272
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Teki6b1978f2014-08-31 21:19:43 +0530273See board/sandbox/README.sandbox for more details.
Simon Glass75b3c3a2014-03-22 17:12:59 -0600274
275
Simon Glassdb910352015-03-03 08:03:00 -0700276Board Initialisation Flow:
277--------------------------
278
279This is the intended start-up flow for boards. This should apply for both
280SPL and U-Boot proper (i.e. they both follow the same rules). At present SPL
281mostly uses a separate code path, but the funtion names and roles of each
282function are the same. Some boards or architectures may not conform to this.
283At least most ARM boards which use CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK conform to this.
284
285Execution starts with start.S with three functions called during init after
286that. The purpose and limitations of each is described below.
287
288lowlevel_init():
289 - purpose: essential init to permit execution to reach board_init_f()
290 - no global_data or BSS
291 - there is no stack (ARMv7 may have one but it will soon be removed)
292 - must not set up SDRAM or use console
293 - must only do the bare minimum to allow execution to continue to
294 board_init_f()
295 - this is almost never needed
296 - return normally from this function
297
298board_init_f():
299 - purpose: set up the machine ready for running board_init_r():
300 i.e. SDRAM and serial UART
301 - global_data is available
302 - stack is in SRAM
303 - BSS is not available, so you cannot use global/static variables,
304 only stack variables and global_data
305
306 Non-SPL-specific notes:
307 - dram_init() is called to set up DRAM. If already done in SPL this
308 can do nothing
309
310 SPL-specific notes:
311 - you can override the entire board_init_f() function with your own
312 version as needed.
313 - preloader_console_init() can be called here in extremis
314 - should set up SDRAM, and anything needed to make the UART work
315 - these is no need to clear BSS, it will be done by crt0.S
316 - must return normally from this function (don't call board_init_r()
317 directly)
318
319Here the BSS is cleared. For SPL, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined, then at
320this point the stack and global_data are relocated to below
321CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR. For non-SPL, U-Boot is relocated to run at the top of
322memory.
323
324board_init_r():
325 - purpose: main execution, common code
326 - global_data is available
327 - SDRAM is available
328 - BSS is available, all static/global variables can be used
329 - execution eventually continues to main_loop()
330
331 Non-SPL-specific notes:
332 - U-Boot is relocated to the top of memory and is now running from
333 there.
334
335 SPL-specific notes:
336 - stack is optionally in SDRAM, if CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R is defined and
337 CONFIG_SPL_STACK_R_ADDR points into SDRAM
338 - preloader_console_init() can be called here - typically this is
339 done by defining CONFIG_SPL_BOARD_INIT and then supplying a
340 spl_board_init() function containing this call
341 - loads U-Boot or (in falcon mode) Linux
342
343
344
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000345Configuration Options:
346----------------------
347
348Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
349such information is kept in a configuration file
350"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
351
352Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
353"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
354
355
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000356Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
357kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
358build a config tool - later.
359
360
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000361The following options need to be configured:
362
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500363- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000364
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500365- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200366
367- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100368 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000369
370- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
371 Define exactly one of
372 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
373--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
374 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
375 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
376
377- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
378 Define exactly one of
379 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
380
381- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
382 Define one or more of
383 CONFIG_CMA302
384
385- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
386 Define one or more of
387 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200388 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000389 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
390
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530391- Marvell Family Member
392 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
393 multiple fs option at one time
394 for marvell soc family
395
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200396- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000397 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
398 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000399 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
400 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000401 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
402 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000403
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000404- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200405 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
406 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000407 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000408 See doc/README.MPC866
409
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200410 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000411
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000412 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
413 of relying on the correctness of the configured
414 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
415 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
416 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200417 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000418
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100419 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
420
421 Define this option if you want to enable the
422 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
423
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600424- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000425 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
426
427 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
428 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
429 compliance, among other possible reasons.
430
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600431 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
432
433 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
434 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
435 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
436
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500437 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
438
439 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
440 tree nodes for the given platform.
441
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000442 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
443
444 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
445 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
446 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
447 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
448 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
449 purpose.
450
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000451 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
452
453 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
454 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
455 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
456
457 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
458 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
459
460 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
461 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
462
463 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
464 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
465 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
466 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
467
468 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
469 this erratum.
470
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530471 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
472 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800473 required during NOR boot.
Prabhakar Kushwaha74fa22e2013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530474
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530475 CONFIG_A008044_WORKAROUND
476 Enables a workaround for T1040/T1042 erratum A008044. It is only
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800477 required during NAND boot and valid for Rev 1.0 SoC revision
Prabhakar Kushwaha9f074e62014-10-29 22:33:09 +0530478
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000479 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
480
481 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
482 according to the A004510 workaround.
483
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530484 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
485 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
486 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
487
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530488 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
489 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
490 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
491
Priyanka Jain64501c62013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530492 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
493 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
494 connected to the DSP core.
495
Priyanka Jain765b0bd2013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530496 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
497 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
498
Priyanka Jainb1359912013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530499 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
500 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
501 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
502 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
503
Aneesh Bansalfb4a2402014-03-18 23:40:26 +0530504 CONFIG_SYS_CPC_REINIT_F
505 This CONFIG is defined when the CPC is configured as SRAM at the
506 time of U-boot entry and is required to be re-initialized.
507
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800508 CONFIG_DEEP_SLEEP
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800509 Indicates this SoC supports deep sleep feature. If deep sleep is
Tang Yuantianaade2002014-04-17 15:33:46 +0800510 supported, core will start to execute uboot when wakes up.
511
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000512- Generic CPU options:
York Sun2a1680e2014-05-02 17:28:04 -0700513 CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_GLOBAL_DATA
514 Defines global data is initialized in generic board board_init_f().
515 If this macro is defined, global data is created and cleared in
516 generic board board_init_f(). Without this macro, architecture/board
517 should initialize global data before calling board_init_f().
518
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000519 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
520
521 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
522 values is arch specific.
523
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700524 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
525 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
526 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
527 SoCs.
528
529 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
530 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
531
532 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
533 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
534 deskew training are not available.
535
536 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
537 Freescale DDR1 controller.
538
539 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
540 Freescale DDR2 controller.
541
542 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
543 Freescale DDR3 controller.
544
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700545 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN4
546 Freescale DDR4 controller.
547
York Sun9ac4ffb2013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700548 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
549 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
550
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700551 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
552 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
553 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
554 implemetation.
555
556 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
557 Board config to use DDR2. It can be eanbeld for SoCs with
558 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
559 implementation.
560
561 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
562 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
York Sun34e026f2014-03-27 17:54:47 -0700563 Freescale DDR3 or DDR3L controllers.
564
565 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3L
566 Board config to use DDR3L. It can be enabled for SoCs with
567 DDR3L controllers.
568
569 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR4
570 Board config to use DDR4. It can be enabled for SoCs with
571 DDR4 controllers.
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700572
Prabhakar Kushwaha1b4175d2014-01-18 12:28:30 +0530573 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_BE
574 Defines the IFC controller register space as Big Endian
575
576 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_IFC_LE
577 Defines the IFC controller register space as Little Endian
578
Prabhakar Kushwaha690e4252014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530579 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
580 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
581 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
582
583 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
584 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
585 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
586 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
587
Prabhakar Kushwaha89ad7be2014-04-08 19:13:34 +0530588 CONFIG_SPL_FSL_PBL
589 It adds a target to create boot binary having SPL binary in PBI format
590 concatenated with u-boot binary.
591
York Sun4e5b1bd2014-02-10 13:59:42 -0800592 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_BE
593 Defines the DDR controller register space as Big Endian
594
595 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_LE
596 Defines the DDR controller register space as Little Endian
597
York Sun6b9e3092014-02-10 13:59:43 -0800598 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_SDRAM_BASE_PHY
599 Physical address from the view of DDR controllers. It is the
600 same as CONFIG_SYS_DDR_SDRAM_BASE for all Power SoCs. But
601 it could be different for ARM SoCs.
602
York Sun6b1e1252014-02-10 13:59:44 -0800603 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_INTLV_256B
604 DDR controller interleaving on 256-byte. This is a special
605 interleaving mode, handled by Dickens for Freescale layerscape
606 SoCs with ARM core.
607
York Sun1d71efb2014-08-01 15:51:00 -0700608 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_MAIN_NUM_CTRLS
609 Number of controllers used as main memory.
610
611 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_OTHER_DDR_NUM_CTRLS
612 Number of controllers used for other than main memory.
613
Prabhakar Kushwaha44937212015-11-09 16:42:07 +0530614 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_HAS_DP_DDR
615 Defines the SoC has DP-DDR used for DPAA.
616
Ruchika Gupta028dbb82014-09-09 11:50:31 +0530617 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_BE
618 Defines the SEC controller register space as Big Endian
619
620 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SEC_LE
621 Defines the SEC controller register space as Little Endian
622
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100623- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200624 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100625
626 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
627 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
628 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
629
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200630 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200631
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100632 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
633 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200634 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100635 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200636
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200637- MIPS CPU options:
638 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
639
640 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
641 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
642 relocation.
643
644 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
645
646 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
647 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
648 Possible values are:
649 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
650 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
651 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
652 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
653 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
654 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
655 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
656 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
657
658 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
659
660 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
661 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
662
663 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
664
665 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
666 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
667 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
668
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000669- ARM options:
670 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
671
672 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
673 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
674
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000675 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
676
677 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
678 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
679 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
680 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
681 GCC.
682
Stephen Warrenc5d47522013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000683 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000684 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
685 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
686 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
Nitin Gargb7588e32014-04-02 08:55:02 -0500687 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_761320
Ian Campbelle392b922015-09-29 10:27:09 +0100688 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_773022
689 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_774769
690 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_794072
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000691
692 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
693 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
694 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
695 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
696 set these options unless they apply!
697
York Sun207774b2015-03-20 19:28:08 -0700698 COUNTER_FREQUENCY
699 Generic timer clock source frequency.
700
701 COUNTER_FREQUENCY_REAL
702 Generic timer clock source frequency if the real clock is
703 different from COUNTER_FREQUENCY, and can only be determined
704 at run time.
705
Nishanth Menonc616a0d2015-03-09 17:11:59 -0500706 NOTE: The following can be machine specific errata. These
707 do have ability to provide rudimentary version and machine
708 specific checks, but expect no product checks.
Nishanth Menon5902f4c2015-03-09 17:12:01 -0500709 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_430973
Nishanth Menonb45c48a2015-03-09 17:12:00 -0500710 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_454179
Nishanth Menon9b4d65f2015-03-09 17:12:02 -0500711 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_621766
Nishanth Menonc616a0d2015-03-09 17:11:59 -0500712 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_798870
Nishanth Menona615d0b2015-07-27 16:26:05 -0500713 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_801819
Nishanth Menonc616a0d2015-03-09 17:11:59 -0500714
Stephen Warren73c38932015-01-19 16:25:52 -0700715- Tegra SoC options:
716 CONFIG_TEGRA_SUPPORT_NON_SECURE
717
718 Support executing U-Boot in non-secure (NS) mode. Certain
719 impossible actions will be skipped if the CPU is in NS mode,
720 such as ARM architectural timer initialization.
721
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000722- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000723 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
724
725 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
726 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
727 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
728 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
729 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
730 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
731 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000732 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100733 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000734 default environment.
735
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000736 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
737
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -0800738 When transferring memsize parameter to Linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000739 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
740 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
741
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400742 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200743
744 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400745 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
746 concepts).
747
748 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
749 * New libfdt-based support
750 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500751 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400752
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200753 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
754 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
755 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
756 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200757 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600758 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200759
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200760 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
761 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500762
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600763 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
764
765 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
766 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000767
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -0600768 CONFIG_OF_SYSTEM_SETUP
769
770 Other code has addition modification that it wants to make
771 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel.
772 This causes ft_system_setup() to be called before booting
773 the kernel.
774
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500775 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
776
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200777 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500778 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
779
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200780 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
781
782 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
783 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
784 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
785 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
786 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
787 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
788
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000789 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
790
791 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
792 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
793 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
794 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
795 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
796 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
797 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
798
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100799- vxWorks boot parameters:
800
801 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
Bin Meng9e98b7e2015-10-07 20:19:17 -0700802 environments variables: bootdev, bootfile, ipaddr, netmask,
803 serverip, gatewayip, hostname, othbootargs.
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100804 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
805
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100806 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
807 the defaults discussed just above.
808
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000809- Cache Configuration:
810 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
811 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
812 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
813
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000814- Cache Configuration for ARM:
815 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
816 controller
817 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
818 controller register space
819
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000820- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200821 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000822
823 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
824
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200825 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000826
827 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
828
829 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
830
831 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
832 the clock speed of the UARTs.
833
834 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
835
836 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
837 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
838 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
839
Karicheri, Muralidharand57dee52014-04-09 15:38:46 -0400840 CONFIG_SERIAL_HW_FLOW_CONTROL
841
842 Define this variable to enable hw flow control in serial driver.
843 Current user of this option is drivers/serial/nsl16550.c driver
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000844
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000845- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000846 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
847 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
848 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
849 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000850
851 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
852 port routines must be defined elsewhere
853 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
854
855 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
856 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000857 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000858 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
859 (default big endian)
860 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
861 rectangle fill
862 (cf. smiLynxEM)
863 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
864 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
865 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
866 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000867 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
868 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000869 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
870 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000871 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000872 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
Simon Glass39f615e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -0700873 (i.e. rx51_kp_init())
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000874 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
Simon Glass39f615e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -0700875 (i.e. rx51_kp_tstc)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000876 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
Simon Glass39f615e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -0700877 (i.e. rx51_kp_getc)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000878 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
879 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000880 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
881 linux_logo.h for logo.
882 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000883 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200884 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000885 the logo
886
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000887 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
888 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
889 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
890
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000891 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
892 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
893 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000894
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000895 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
896 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
897 the "silent" environment variable. See
898 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000899
Heiko Schocher45ae2542013-10-22 11:06:06 +0200900 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BG_COL: define the backgroundcolor, default
901 is 0x00.
902 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_FG_COL: define the foregroundcolor, default
903 is 0xa0.
904
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000905- Console Baudrate:
906 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
907 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200908 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
909 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000910
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100911- Console Rx buffer length
912 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
913 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100914 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100915 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
916 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
917 the SMC.
918
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000919- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200920 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
921 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
922 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
923 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
924 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
925 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
926 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200927 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200928 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000929
Hans de Goedea8552c72015-05-05 13:13:36 +0200930 Note that when printing the buffer a copy is made on the
931 stack so CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ must fit on the stack.
932
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200933 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
934 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000935
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000936- Safe printf() functions
937 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
938 the printf() functions. These are defined in
939 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
940 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
941 If this option is not given then these functions will
942 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
943 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
944
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000945- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
946 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
947 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000948 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
949 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000950
951 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
952 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
953 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
954 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
955 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
956 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
957 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
958 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000959 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
960 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
961
962- Autoboot Command:
963 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
964 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
965 define a command string that is automatically executed
966 when no character is read on the console interface
967 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
968
969 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000970 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
971 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
972 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000973
974 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000975 The value of these goes into the environment as
976 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
977 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200978 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000979
Heiko Schochereda0ba32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100980- Bootcount:
981 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
982 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
983 cycle, see:
984 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
985
986 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
987 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
988 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
989 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
990 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
991 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
992 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
993 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
994 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
995
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000996- Pre-Boot Commands:
997 CONFIG_PREBOOT
998
999 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
1000 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
1001 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
1002 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
1003 entering interactive mode.
1004
1005 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
1006 automatically generated or modified. For an example
1007 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
1008 modified when the user holds down a certain
1009 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
1010 booting the systems
1011
1012- Serial Download Echo Mode:
1013 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
1014 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
1015 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
1016 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
1017 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
1018 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
1019 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
1020
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001021- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001022 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
1023 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001024 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001025
1026- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001027 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
1028 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +00001029 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
Joe Hershbergeref0f2f52015-06-22 16:15:30 -05001030 commands, or adding #define's for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001031
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001032 The default command configuration includes all commands
1033 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001034
Marek Vasutb401b732014-03-05 19:58:39 +01001035 CONFIG_CMD_AES AES 128 CBC encrypt/decrypt
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001036 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001037 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
1038 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
1039 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
1040 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
1041 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
Tom Rinid2b2ffe2014-08-14 06:42:36 -04001042 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTI * ARM64 Linux kernel Image support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001043 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
Michal Simek08d0d6f2013-11-21 13:39:02 -08001044 CONFIG_CMD_CLK * clock command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001045 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -05001046 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001047 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
1048 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
1049 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -06001050 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
1051 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
1052 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
1053 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001054 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
1055 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -05001056 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001057 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
1058 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -06001059 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -06001060 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Andrew Ruder88733e22013-10-22 19:07:34 -05001061 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_EXISTS * check existence of env variable
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001062 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001063 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
1064 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Stephen Warren16f4d932014-01-24 20:46:37 -07001065 CONFIG_CMD_FS_GENERIC * filesystem commands (e.g. load, ls)
1066 that work for multiple fs types
Christian Gmeiner59e890e2014-11-12 14:35:04 +01001067 CONFIG_CMD_FS_UUID * Look up a filesystem UUID
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -05001068 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001069 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +00001070 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001071 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
1072 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001073 CONFIG_CMD_FUSE * Device fuse support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +00001074 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -05001075 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +00001076 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00001077 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001078 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
1079 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
1080 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
1081 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +00001082 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001083 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND * List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001084 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001085 CONFIG_CMD_IOTRACE * I/O tracing for debugging
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -05001086 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +00001087 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001088 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
1089 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
1090 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
1091 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001092 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO * ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001093 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
1094 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001095 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
1096 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001097 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM * print md5 message digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001098 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +00001099 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001100 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +00001101 loop, loopw
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001102 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST * mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001103 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
1104 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
1105 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +01001106 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001107 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
1108 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001109 CONFIG_CMD_NFS NFS support
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001110 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00001111 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001112 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
1113 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
1114 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
1115 host
1116 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +00001117 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001118 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
1119 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +00001120 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001121 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
1122 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
1123 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
1124 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
1125 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
1126 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07001127 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001128 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM * print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -04001129 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Bob Liu7d861d92013-02-05 19:05:41 +08001130 CONFIG_CMD_SOFTSWITCH * Soft switch setting command for BF60x
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02001131 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001132 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +00001133 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00001134 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +00001135 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
1136 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001137 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001138 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +00001139 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
Vincent Stehlé4d98b5c2013-06-20 18:14:22 +02001140 CONFIG_CMD_XIMG Load part of Multi Image
Przemyslaw Marczak89c82302014-04-02 10:20:05 +02001141 CONFIG_CMD_UUID * Generate random UUID or GUID string
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001142
1143 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
1144 support you can write:
1145
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001146 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
1147 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001148
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -04001149 Other Commands:
1150 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001151
1152 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001153 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001154 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
1155 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
1156 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
1157 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
1158 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
1159 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001160
1161
1162 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
1163
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001164- Regular expression support:
1165 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001166 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
1167 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
1168 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
1169 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denka5ecbe62013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001170
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001171- Device tree:
1172 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
1173 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
1174 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
1175 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
1176 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
1177 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
1178
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001179 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
1180 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +00001181
1182 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
1183 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
1184 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
1185 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
1186 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
1187 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001188
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001189 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
1190 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
1191 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
1192 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
1193
1194 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
1195
1196 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
1197 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
1198 still use the individual files if you need something more
1199 exotic.
1200
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001201- Watchdog:
1202 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
1203 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00001204 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
1205 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
1206 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
1207 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
1208 available, then no further board specific code should
1209 be needed to use it.
1210
1211 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
1212 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
1213 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
1214 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001215
Heiko Schocher7bae0d62015-01-21 08:38:22 +01001216 CONFIG_AT91_HW_WDT_TIMEOUT
1217 specify the timeout in seconds. default 2 seconds.
1218
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001219- U-Boot Version:
1220 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
1221 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
1222 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
1223 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +02001224 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
1225 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001226
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001227- Real-Time Clock:
1228
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001229 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001230 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
1231 following options:
1232
1233 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1234 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001235 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001236 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001237 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001238 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001239 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
Markus Niebel412921d2014-07-21 11:06:16 +02001240 CONFIG_RTC_DS1339 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1339 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001241 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001242 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001243 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001244 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001245 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1246 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001247
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001248 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1249 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1250
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001251- GPIO Support:
1252 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001253
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001254 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1255 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1256 pins supported by a particular chip.
1257
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001258 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1259 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1260
Simon Glassaa532332014-06-11 23:29:41 -06001261- I/O tracing:
1262 When CONFIG_IO_TRACE is selected, U-Boot intercepts all I/O
1263 accesses and can checksum them or write a list of them out
1264 to memory. See the 'iotrace' command for details. This is
1265 useful for testing device drivers since it can confirm that
1266 the driver behaves the same way before and after a code
1267 change. Currently this is supported on sandbox and arm. To
1268 add support for your architecture, add '#include <iotrace.h>'
1269 to the bottom of arch/<arch>/include/asm/io.h and test.
1270
1271 Example output from the 'iotrace stats' command is below.
1272 Note that if the trace buffer is exhausted, the checksum will
1273 still continue to operate.
1274
1275 iotrace is enabled
1276 Start: 10000000 (buffer start address)
1277 Size: 00010000 (buffer size)
1278 Offset: 00000120 (current buffer offset)
1279 Output: 10000120 (start + offset)
1280 Count: 00000018 (number of trace records)
1281 CRC32: 9526fb66 (CRC32 of all trace records)
1282
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001283- Timestamp Support:
1284
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001285 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1286 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1287 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001288 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001289
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001290- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1291 Zero or more of the following:
1292 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1293 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1294 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1295 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1296 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1297 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1298 disk/part_efi.c
1299 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001300
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001301 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1302 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001303 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001304
1305- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001306 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1307 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001308
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001309 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1310 be performed by calling the function
1311 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1312 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001313
1314- ATAPI Support:
1315 CONFIG_ATAPI
1316
1317 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1318
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001319- LBA48 Support
1320 CONFIG_LBA48
1321
1322 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001323 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001324 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1325 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1326
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001327 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001328 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1329 Default is 32bit.
1330
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001331- SCSI Support:
1332 At the moment only there is only support for the
1333 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1334 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1335
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001336 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1337 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1338 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001339 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1340 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001341 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001342
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001343 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1344 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001345
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001346- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001347 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001348 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1349
1350 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1351 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1352 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1353 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1354
1355 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1356 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1357 example with the "sspi" command.
1358
1359 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1360 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1361 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001362
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001363 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1364 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001365 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001366 write routine for first time initialisation.
1367
1368 CONFIG_TULIP
1369 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1370 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1371 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1372
1373 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1374 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1375
1376 CONFIG_NS8382X
1377 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1378
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001379- NETWORK Support (other):
1380
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001381 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1382 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1383
1384 CONFIG_RMII
1385 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1386
1387 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1388 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1389 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1390
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001391 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1392 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1393
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001394 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001395 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1396
1397 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1398 Define this to hold the physical address
1399 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1400
1401 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1402 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1403
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001404 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001405 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1406
1407 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1408 Define this to hold the physical address
1409 of the device (I/O space)
1410
1411 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1412 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1413
1414 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1415 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1416 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1417
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001418 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1419 Support for davinci emac
1420
1421 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1422 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1423
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001424 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1425 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1426
1427 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1428 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1429 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1430 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1431 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1432 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1433 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1434 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1435
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001436 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001437 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1438
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001439 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001440 Define this to hold the physical address
1441 of the device (I/O space)
1442
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001443 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001444 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1445
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001446 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001447 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1448 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001449 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001450
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001451 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1452 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1453
1454 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1455 Define the number of ports to be used
1456
1457 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1458 Define the ETH PHY's address
1459
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001460 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1461 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1462
Heiko Schocherb2f97cf2014-07-18 06:07:19 +02001463- PWM Support:
1464 CONFIG_PWM_IMX
1465 Support for PWM modul on the imx6.
1466
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001467- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001468 CONFIG_TPM
1469 Support TPM devices.
1470
Christophe Ricard0766ad22015-10-06 22:54:41 +02001471 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_INFINEON
1472 Support for Infineon i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001473 per system is supported at this time.
1474
Tom Wai-Hong Tam1b393db2013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001475 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1476 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1477
Dirk Eibachc01939c2013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001478 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1479 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1480
Che-liang Chiou90899cc2013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001481 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001482 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1483 per system is supported at this time.
1484
1485 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1486 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1487 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1488 0xfed40000.
1489
Reinhard Pfaube6c1522013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001490 CONFIG_CMD_TPM
1491 Add tpm monitor functions.
1492 Requires CONFIG_TPM. If CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS is set, also
1493 provides monitor access to authorized functions.
1494
1495 CONFIG_TPM
1496 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1497 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1498 Requires support for a TPM device.
1499
1500 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1501 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1502 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1503
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001504- USB Support:
1505 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001506 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001507 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1508 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001509 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001510 storage devices.
1511 Note:
1512 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1513 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001514 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1515 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1516 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001517 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1518 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001519 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1520 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1521 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001522 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1523 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001524 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001525 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1526 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001527
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001528 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1529 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1530
Oleksandr Tymoshenko6e9e0622014-02-01 21:51:25 -07001531 CONFIG_USB_DWC2_REG_ADDR the physical CPU address of the DWC2
1532 HW module registers.
1533
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001534- USB Device:
1535 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1536 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1537 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001538 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001539 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1540 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001541 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001542 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1543 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1544 a Linux host by
1545 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1546 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1547 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1548 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001549
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001550 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1551 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001552
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001553 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1554 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1555 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001556
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301557 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1558 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1559 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1560 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1561 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1562 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1563 speed.
1564
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001565 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001566 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1567 be set to usbtty.
1568
1569 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001570 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001571 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001572 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001573
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001574 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001575 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001576 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001577
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001578 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001579 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001580 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001581 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1582 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1583 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1584
1585 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1586 Define this string as the name of your company for
1587 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001588
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001589 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1590 Define this string as the name of your product
1591 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1592
1593 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1594 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1595 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1596 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1597 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001598
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001599 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1600 Define this as the unique Product ID
1601 for your device
1602 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001603
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001604- ULPI Layer Support:
1605 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1606 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1607 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1608 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1609 viewport is supported.
1610 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1611 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001612 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1613 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1614 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001615
1616- MMC Support:
1617 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1618 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1619 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1620 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001621 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1622 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001623
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001624 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1625 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1626
1627 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1628 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1629
1630 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1631 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1632
Pierre Aubert1fd93c62014-04-24 10:30:08 +02001633 CONFIG_GENERIC_MMC
1634 Enable the generic MMC driver
1635
1636 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_BOOT
1637 Enable some additional features of the eMMC boot partitions.
1638
1639 CONFIG_SUPPORT_EMMC_RPMB
1640 Enable the commands for reading, writing and programming the
1641 key for the Replay Protection Memory Block partition in eMMC.
1642
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001643- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
Paul Kocialkowski01acd6a2015-06-12 19:56:58 +02001644 CONFIG_USB_FUNCTION_DFU
Tom Rinib3ba6e92013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001645 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1646
1647 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1648 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1649 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1650 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1651 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1652
1653 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1654 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1655
Pantelis Antoniouc6631762013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001656 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1657 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1658
Afzal Mohammeda9479f02013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301659 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1660 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1661 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1662 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1663 one that would help mostly the developer.
1664
Heiko Schochere7e75c72013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001665 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1666 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1667 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1668 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1669 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1670
Pantelis Antoniouea2453d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001671 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1672 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1673 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1674 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1675 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1676 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1677
Heiko Schocher001a8312014-03-18 08:09:56 +01001678 DFU_DEFAULT_POLL_TIMEOUT
1679 Poll timeout [ms], is the timeout a device can send to the
1680 host. The host must wait for this timeout before sending
1681 a subsequent DFU_GET_STATUS request to the device.
1682
1683 DFU_MANIFEST_POLL_TIMEOUT
1684 Poll timeout [ms], which the device sends to the host when
1685 entering dfuMANIFEST state. Host waits this timeout, before
1686 sending again an USB request to the device.
1687
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001688- USB Device Android Fastboot support:
Paul Kocialkowski17da3c02015-06-12 19:56:59 +02001689 CONFIG_USB_FUNCTION_FASTBOOT
1690 This enables the USB part of the fastboot gadget
1691
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001692 CONFIG_CMD_FASTBOOT
1693 This enables the command "fastboot" which enables the Android
1694 fastboot mode for the platform's USB device. Fastboot is a USB
1695 protocol for downloading images, flashing and device control
1696 used on Android devices.
1697 See doc/README.android-fastboot for more information.
1698
1699 CONFIG_ANDROID_BOOT_IMAGE
1700 This enables support for booting images which use the Android
1701 image format header.
1702
Paul Kocialkowskia588d992015-07-20 12:38:22 +02001703 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_BUF_ADDR
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001704 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1705 downloads. Define this to the starting RAM address to use for
1706 downloaded images.
1707
Paul Kocialkowskia588d992015-07-20 12:38:22 +02001708 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_BUF_SIZE
Sebastian Siewior3aab70a2014-05-05 15:08:10 -05001709 The fastboot protocol requires a large memory buffer for
1710 downloads. This buffer should be as large as possible for a
1711 platform. Define this to the size available RAM for fastboot.
1712
Steve Raed1b5ed02014-08-26 11:47:28 -07001713 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH
1714 The fastboot protocol includes a "flash" command for writing
1715 the downloaded image to a non-volatile storage device. Define
1716 this to enable the "fastboot flash" command.
1717
1718 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_FLASH_MMC_DEV
1719 The fastboot "flash" command requires additional information
1720 regarding the non-volatile storage device. Define this to
1721 the eMMC device that fastboot should use to store the image.
1722
Steve Rae0ff7e582014-12-12 15:51:54 -08001723 CONFIG_FASTBOOT_GPT_NAME
1724 The fastboot "flash" command supports writing the downloaded
1725 image to the Protective MBR and the Primary GUID Partition
1726 Table. (Additionally, this downloaded image is post-processed
1727 to generate and write the Backup GUID Partition Table.)
1728 This occurs when the specified "partition name" on the
1729 "fastboot flash" command line matches this value.
1730 Default is GPT_ENTRY_NAME (currently "gpt") if undefined.
1731
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001732- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1733 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1734 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1735 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1736
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001737 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1738 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001739 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1740
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001741 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001742 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1743 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1744
1745 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001746 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001747 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1748 have not defined a custom partition
1749
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001750- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1751 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001752
1753 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1754 file in FAT formatted partition.
1755
1756 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1757 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001758
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001759CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1760 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1761
1762 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1763 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1764 and cbfsload.
1765
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu4f0d1a22014-05-26 19:18:37 +05301766- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem cluster size:
1767 CONFIG_FS_FAT_MAX_CLUSTSIZE
1768
1769 Define the max cluster size for fat operations else
1770 a default value of 65536 will be defined.
1771
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001772- Keyboard Support:
Simon Glass39f615e2015-11-11 10:05:47 -07001773 See Kconfig help for available keyboard drivers.
1774
1775 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
1776
1777 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1778 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1779 defined in your board-specific files. This option is deprecated
1780 and is only used by novena. For new boards, use driver model
1781 instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001782
1783- Video support:
1784 CONFIG_VIDEO
1785
1786 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1787 video).
1788
1789 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1790
1791 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1792
1793 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001794 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001795 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1796 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1797 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001798
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001799 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001800 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001801 are possible:
1802 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001803 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001804
1805 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1806 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1807 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1808 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1809 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1810 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1811 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001812 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1813
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001814 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001815 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001816
1817
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001818 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001819 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001820 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1821 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1822
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001823 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001824 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001825 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1826 support, and should also define these other macros:
1827
1828 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1829 CONFIG_VIDEO
1830 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1831 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1832 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1833 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1834 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1835 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1836
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001837 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1838 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1839 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1840 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001841
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001842- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1843
1844 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1845 display); also select one of the supported displays
1846 by defining one of these:
1847
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001848 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1849
1850 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1851
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001852 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001853
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001854 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001855
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001856 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001857
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001858 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1859 Active, color, single scan.
1860
1861 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1862
1863 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001864 Active, color, single scan.
1865
1866 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1867
1868 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1869 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1870
1871 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1872
1873 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1874 Active, color, single scan.
1875
1876 CONFIG_HLD1045
1877
1878 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1879 Active, color, single scan.
1880
1881 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1882
1883 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1884 or
1885 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1886 or
1887 Hitachi SP14Q002
1888
1889 320x240. Black & white.
1890
1891 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001892 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001893
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001894 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1895
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001896 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (typically 4KB). If this is
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001897 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1898 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1899 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1900 a per-section basis.
1901
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001902 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1903
1904 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1905 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1906 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1907 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001908
Hannes Petermaier604c7d42015-03-27 08:01:38 +01001909 CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION
1910
1911 Sometimes, for example if the display is mounted in portrait
1912 mode or even if it's mounted landscape but rotated by 180degree,
1913 we need to rotate our content of the display relative to the
1914 framebuffer, so that user can read the messages which are
1915 printed out.
1916 Once CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is defined, the lcd_console will be
1917 initialized with a given rotation from "vl_rot" out of
1918 "vidinfo_t" which is provided by the board specific code.
1919 The value for vl_rot is coded as following (matching to
1920 fbcon=rotate:<n> linux-kernel commandline):
1921 0 = no rotation respectively 0 degree
1922 1 = 90 degree rotation
1923 2 = 180 degree rotation
1924 3 = 270 degree rotation
1925
1926 If CONFIG_LCD_ROTATION is not defined, the console will be
1927 initialized with 0degree rotation.
1928
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001929 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1930
1931 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1932
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001933 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1934
1935 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1936 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1937
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001938- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001939
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001940 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1941 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1942 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001943 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001944 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1945 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1946 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1947 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001948
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001949 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1950
1951 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1952 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
Tom Rini1551df32014-02-25 10:27:01 -05001953 (see README.displaying-bmps).
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001954 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1955 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1956 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1957 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1958 there is no need to set this option.
1959
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001960 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1961
1962 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1963 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1964 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1965 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1966 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1967 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1968
1969 Example:
1970 setenv splashpos m,m
1971 => image at center of screen
1972
1973 setenv splashpos 30,20
1974 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1975
1976 setenv splashpos -10,m
1977 => vertically centered image
1978 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1979
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001980- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1981
1982 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1983 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1984 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1985
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001986- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1987
1988 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1989 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1990 bmp command.
1991
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08001992- Do compressing for memory range:
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001993 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1994
1995 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1996 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1997
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001998- Compression support:
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001999 CONFIG_GZIP
2000
2001 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
2002
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00002003 CONFIG_BZIP2
2004
2005 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
2006 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
2007 compressed images are supported.
2008
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002009 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002010 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00002011 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00002012
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02002013 CONFIG_LZMA
2014
2015 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
2016 images is included.
2017
2018 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
2019 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
2020 formula:
2021
2022 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
2023
2024 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
2025 and Literal pos bits.
2026
2027 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
2028 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
2029 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
2030 a very small buffer.
2031
2032 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
2033 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002034 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02002035
Kees Cook8ef70472013-08-16 07:59:12 -07002036 CONFIG_LZO
2037
2038 If this option is set, support for LZO compressed images
2039 is included.
2040
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002041- MII/PHY support:
2042 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
2043
2044 The address of PHY on MII bus.
2045
2046 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
2047
2048 The clock frequency of the MII bus
2049
2050 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
2051
2052 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002053 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002054
2055 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
2056
2057 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
2058 reset before any MII register access is possible.
2059 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
2060 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
2061
2062 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
2063
2064 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
2065 command issued before MII status register can be read
2066
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002067- IP address:
2068 CONFIG_IPADDR
2069
2070 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002071 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002072 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002073 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002074
2075- Server IP address:
2076 CONFIG_SERVERIP
2077
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002078 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002079 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002080 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002081
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04002082 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
2083
2084 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
2085 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
2086
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00002087- Gateway IP address:
2088 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
2089
2090 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
2091 default router where packets to other networks are
2092 sent to.
2093 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
2094
2095- Subnet mask:
2096 CONFIG_NETMASK
2097
2098 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
2099 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
2100 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
2101 forwarded through a router.
2102 (Environment variable "netmask")
2103
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002104- Multicast TFTP Mode:
2105 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
2106
2107 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
2108 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002109 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05002110 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
2111 multicast group.
2112
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002113- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
2114 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
2115
2116 If you have many targets in a network that try to
2117 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
2118 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
2119 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
2120 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
2121 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
2122 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
2123 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02002124 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002125
2126 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
2127 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
2128 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
2129 4th and following
2130 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
2131
Thierry Reding92ac8ac2014-08-19 10:21:24 +02002132 CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE
2133
2134 BOOTP packets are uniquely identified using a 32-bit ID. The
2135 server will copy the ID from client requests to responses and
2136 U-Boot will use this to determine if it is the destination of
2137 an incoming response. Some servers will check that addresses
2138 aren't in use before handing them out (usually using an ARP
2139 ping) and therefore take up to a few hundred milliseconds to
2140 respond. Network congestion may also influence the time it
2141 takes for a response to make it back to the client. If that
2142 time is too long, U-Boot will retransmit requests. In order
2143 to allow earlier responses to still be accepted after these
2144 retransmissions, U-Boot's BOOTP client keeps a small cache of
2145 IDs. The CONFIG_BOOTP_ID_CACHE_SIZE controls the size of this
2146 cache. The default is to keep IDs for up to four outstanding
2147 requests. Increasing this will allow U-Boot to accept offers
2148 from a BOOTP client in networks with unusually high latency.
2149
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002150- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002151 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
2152 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002153
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002154 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
2155 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
2156 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
2157 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
2158 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
2159 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
2160 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
2161 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
2162 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
2163 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
2164 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
2165 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002166 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002167
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002168 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
2169 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002170
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00002171 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
2172 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
2173 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
2174 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
2175 is not available.
2176
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002177 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
2178 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
2179 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
2180 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
2181 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
2182 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
2183 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002184 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002185
2186 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
2187 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
2188 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04002189 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05002190 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
2191 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00002192
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11002193 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
2194
2195 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
2196 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
2197 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
2198 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
2199 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
2200 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
2201 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
2202 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
2203 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
2204 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
2205 this delay.
2206
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00002207 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
2208 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
2209 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
2210 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
2211 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
2212
2213 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
2214
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002215 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00002216 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002217
2218 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
2219
2220 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
2221
2222 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
2223 of the device.
2224
2225 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
2226
2227 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
2228 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002229 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00002230
2231 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
2232
2233 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
2234 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
2235
2236 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
2237
2238 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
2239
2240 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
2241
2242 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
2243
2244 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
2245
2246 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
2247
2248 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
2249
2250 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
2251 device in .1 of milliwatts.
2252
2253 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
2254
2255 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
2256
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002257- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
2258
2259 Several configurations allow to display the current
2260 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
2261 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
2262 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
2263 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
2264 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
2265 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
2266 feature in U-Boot.
2267
Igor Grinberg1df7bbb2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02002268 Additional options:
2269
2270 CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2271 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
2272 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
2273 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2274 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
2275
Igor Grinberg9dfdcdf2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02002276 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
2277 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
2278 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
2279 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
2280 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
2281 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
2282
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002283- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
2284
2285 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
2286 on those systems that support this (optional)
2287 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
2288
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002289- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002290
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002291 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
2292 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
2293 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
2294 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
2295 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
2296 interface.
2297
2298 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002299 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
2300 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
2301 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
2302 for defining speed and slave address
2303 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
2304 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
2305 for defining speed and slave address
2306 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
2307 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
2308 for defining speed and slave address
2309 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
2310 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
2311 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002312
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002313 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
2314 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
2315 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
2316 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
2317 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
2318 bus.
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002319 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocher00f792e2012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002320 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
2321 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
2322 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
2323 second bus.
2324
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002325 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu10cee512013-10-11 16:23:53 +09002326 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
2327 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
2328 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass1f2ba722012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002329
Dirk Eibach880540d2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00002330 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
2331 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
2332 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2333 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2334
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002335 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
2336 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)03544c62015-09-21 22:43:38 +02002337 - enable bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C1
2338 - enable bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C2
2339 - enable bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C3
2340 - enable bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC_I2C4
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002341 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
2342 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
2343 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
2344 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
2345 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
2346 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
Albert ARIBAUD \\(3ADEV\\)03544c62015-09-21 22:43:38 +02002347 - define speed for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SPEED
2348 - define slave for bus 4 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C4_SLAVE
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002349 If those defines are not set, default value is 100000
tremfac96402013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002350 for speed, and 0 for slave.
2351
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu1086bfa2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09002352 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
2353 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
2354 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
2355
2356 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
2357 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
2358 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
2359 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
2360 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
2361 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
2362 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
2363 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
2364 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
2365
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002366 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
2367 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
2368 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
2369
2370 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
2371 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
2372 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
2373 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
2374 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
2375 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
2376 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
2377 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
2378 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
2379 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
2380 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE5 for setting the register channel 5
2381 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED5 for for the speed channel 5
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002382 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu2035d772013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002383
Heiko Schocher6789e842013-10-22 11:03:18 +02002384 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
2385 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
2386 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
2387 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
2388 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
2389 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
2390 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
2391 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
2392 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
2393 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
2394 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
2395 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
2396
Heiko Schocher0bdffe72013-11-08 07:30:53 +01002397 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
2398 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
2399 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
2400 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
2401
Naveen Krishna Che717fc62013-12-06 12:12:38 +05302402 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
2403 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
2404 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
2405 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
2406 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
2407
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02002408 - drivers/i2c/ihs_i2c.c
2409 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS
2410 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2411 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0 speed channel 0
2412 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0 slave addr channel 0
2413 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2414 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1 speed channel 1
2415 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1 slave addr channel 1
2416 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH2 activate hardware channel 2
2417 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2 speed channel 2
2418 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2 slave addr channel 2
2419 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_CH3 activate hardware channel 3
2420 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3 speed channel 3
2421 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3 slave addr channel 3
Dirk Eibach071be892015-10-28 11:46:22 +01002422 - activate dual channel with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_DUAL
2423 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_0_1 speed channel 0_1
2424 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_0_1 slave addr channel 0_1
2425 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_1_1 speed channel 1_1
2426 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_1_1 slave addr channel 1_1
2427 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_2_1 speed channel 2_1
2428 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_2_1 slave addr channel 2_1
2429 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SPEED_3_1 speed channel 3_1
2430 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_IHS_SLAVE_3_1 slave addr channel 3_1
Dirk Eibachb46226b2014-07-03 09:28:18 +02002431
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002432 additional defines:
2433
2434 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002435 Hold the number of i2c buses you want to use. If you
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002436 don't use/have i2c muxes on your i2c bus, this
2437 is equal to CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_ADAPTERS, and you can
2438 omit this define.
2439
2440 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
2441 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
2442 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
2443 omit this define.
2444
2445 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
2446 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
2447 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
2448 define.
2449
2450 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002451 hold a list of buses you want to use, only used if
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002452 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
2453 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
2454 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
2455
2456 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2457 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
2458 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
2459 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
2460 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
2461 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
2462 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2463 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
2464 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
2465 }
2466
2467 which defines
2468 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002469 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
2470 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
2471 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
2472 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
2473 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002474 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002475 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
2476 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002477
2478 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
2479
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002480- Legacy I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C
Heiko Schocher3f4978c2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002481
2482 NOTE: It is intended to move drivers to CONFIG_SYS_I2C which
2483 provides the following compelling advantages:
2484
2485 - more than one i2c adapter is usable
2486 - approved multibus support
2487 - better i2c mux support
2488
2489 ** Please consider updating your I2C driver now. **
2490
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002491 These enable legacy I2C serial bus commands. Defining
2492 CONFIG_HARD_I2C will include the appropriate I2C driver
2493 for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002494
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002495 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05002496 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002497 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
2498 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002499 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002500
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002501 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002502
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002503 There are several other quantities that must also be
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002504 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002505
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002506 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002507 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002508 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002509 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002510
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002511 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002512 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002513 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
2514 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
2515 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002516
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05002517 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
2518
2519 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2520 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2521 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
2522 commands until the slave device responds.
2523
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002524 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002525
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002526 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002527 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
2528 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002529
2530 I2C_INIT
2531
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002532 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002533 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002534
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002535 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002536
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002537 I2C_PORT
2538
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002539 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
2540 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
2541 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002542
2543 I2C_ACTIVE
2544
2545 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
2546 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
2547 define can be null.
2548
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002549 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
2550
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002551 I2C_TRISTATE
2552
2553 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
2554 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
2555 define can be null.
2556
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002557 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
2558
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002559 I2C_READ
2560
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002561 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
2562 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002563
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002564 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
2565
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002566 I2C_SDA(bit)
2567
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002568 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
2569 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002570
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002571 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002572 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002573 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002574
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002575 I2C_SCL(bit)
2576
York Sun472d5462013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002577 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
2578 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002579
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002580 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002581 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002582 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002583
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002584 I2C_DELAY
2585
2586 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
2587 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002588 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002589 like:
2590
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002591 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002592
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002593 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2594
2595 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2596 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2597 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2598 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2599
2600 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2601 the generic GPIO functions.
2602
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002603 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002604
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002605 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2606 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2607 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2608 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2609 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2610 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2611 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2612 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002613
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002614 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2615
2616 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2617 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2618 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2619 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2620 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2621 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2622 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2623 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2624
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002625 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2626
2627 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2628 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2629 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2630
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002631 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2632
2633 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002634 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2635 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002636 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2637
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002638 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002639
2640 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002641 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002642 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2643 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002644
2645 e.g.
2646 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002647 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002648
2649 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2650
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002651 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002652 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002653
2654 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2655
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002656 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002657
2658 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2659 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2660
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002661 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002662
2663 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2664 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2665
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002666 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002667
2668 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2669 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2670
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002671 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002672
2673 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2674 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2675 specified DTT device.
2676
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002677 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2678
2679 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2680 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2681 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2682 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2683 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2684 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2685 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002686
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002687- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2688
2689 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2690 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2691 D/As on the SACSng board)
2692
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002693 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2694
2695 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2696 only SH7757 is supported.
2697
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002698 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2699
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002700 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2701 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2702 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2703 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2704 defined, the board configuration must define several
2705 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2706 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002707
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002708 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2709
2710 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2711 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2712 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002713 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002714 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2715
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002716 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2717
2718 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002719 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002720
Heiko Schocherf659b572014-07-14 10:22:11 +02002721 CONFIG_SYS_SPI_MXC_WAIT
2722 Timeout for waiting until spi transfer completed.
2723 default: (CONFIG_SYS_HZ/100) /* 10 ms */
2724
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002725- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2726
2727 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2728
2729 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2730
2731 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2732 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2733
2734 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2735
2736 Enables support for FPGA family.
2737 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2738
2739 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002740
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002741 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002742
Siva Durga Prasad Paladugu64e809a2014-03-14 16:35:38 +05302743 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADMK
2744
2745 Enable support for fpga loadmk command
2746
Michal Simek67193862014-05-02 13:43:39 +02002747 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADP
2748
2749 Enable support for fpga loadp command - load partial bitstream
2750
2751 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA_LOADBP
2752
2753 Enable support for fpga loadbp command - load partial bitstream
2754 (Xilinx only)
2755
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002756 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002757
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002758 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002759
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002760 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002761
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002762 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2763 status by the configuration function. This option
2764 will require a board or device specific function to
2765 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002766
2767 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2768
2769 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2770 configuration driver.
2771
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002772 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002773 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2774
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002775 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002776
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002777 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2778 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2779 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2780 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002781
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002782 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002783
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002784 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to de-assert
2785 after PROB_B has been de-asserted during a Virtex II
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002786 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002787 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002788
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002789 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002790
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002791 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to de-assert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002792 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002793
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002794 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002795
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002796 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002797 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002798
2799- Configuration Management:
Stefan Roeseb2b8a692014-10-22 12:13:24 +02002800 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET
2801
2802 Some SoCs need special image types (e.g. U-Boot binary
2803 with a special header) as build targets. By defining
2804 CONFIG_BUILD_TARGET in the SoC / board header, this
2805 special image will be automatically built upon calling
2806 make / MAKEALL.
2807
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002808 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2809
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002810 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2811 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002812
2813- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2814
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002815 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2816 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002817 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002818 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2819 protects these variables from casual modification by
2820 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2821 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002822 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002823
2824 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2825 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002826 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002827 these parameters.
2828
Joe Hershberger92ac5202015-05-04 14:55:14 -05002829 Alternatively, if you define _both_ an ethaddr in the
2830 default env _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002831 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002832 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2833 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2834 read-only.]
2835
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002836 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2837 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2838 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2839 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2840
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002841- Protected RAM:
2842 CONFIG_PRAM
2843
2844 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2845 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2846 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2847 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2848 this default value by defining an environment
2849 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2850 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2851 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2852 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2853 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2854 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2855 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2856
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002857 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002858 saveenv
2859
2860 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2861 either, which results in a memory region that will
2862 not be affected by reboots.
2863
2864 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2865 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2866 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2867 following board configurations are known to be
2868 "pRAM-clean":
2869
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002870 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2871 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002872 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002873
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002874- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2875 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2876 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2877 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2878 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2879 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2880 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2881
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002882- Error Recovery:
2883 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2884
2885 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2886 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2887 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002888 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002889 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2890 useful during development since you can try to debug
2891 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2892
2893 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2894
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002895 This variable defines the number of retries for
2896 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2897 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2898 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002899
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002900 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2901
2902 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2903
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002904 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2905
2906 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2907 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2908 try longer timeout such as
2909 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2910
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002911- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002912 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002913
2914 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2915
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002916 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002917
2918 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2919 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2920 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2921
2922 Note:
2923
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002924 In the current implementation, the local variables
2925 space and global environment variables space are
2926 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2927 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2928 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2929 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2930 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002931
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002932 Global environment variables are those you use
2933 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2934 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2935 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002936
2937 To store commands and special characters in a
2938 variable, please use double quotation marks
2939 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2940 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2941 symbols.
2942
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002943- Command Line Editing and History:
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002944 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2945
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002946 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002947 command line input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002948
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002949- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002950 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2951
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002952 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2953 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002954 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002955
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002956 For example, place something like this in your
2957 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002958
2959 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2960 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2961 "myvar2=value2\0"
2962
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002963 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2964 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2965 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2966 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002967 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002968 You better know what you are doing here.
2969
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002970 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2971 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002972 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002973 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002974
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002975 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2976
2977 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2978 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2979 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2980
2981 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2982
2983 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2984 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2985 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2986 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2987 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2988
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002989 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2990
2991 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2992 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2993 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2994
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002995 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2996
2997 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08002998 initialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002999 that so that the environment is not available until
3000 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
3001 this is instead controlled by the value of
3002 /config/load-environment.
3003
Chris Packham3b10cf12015-06-19 20:25:59 +12003004- Parallel Flash support:
3005 CONFIG_SYS_NO_FLASH
3006
3007 Traditionally U-boot was run on systems with parallel NOR
3008 flash. This option is used to disable support for parallel NOR
3009 flash. This option should be defined if the board does not have
3010 parallel flash.
3011
3012 If this option is not defined one of the generic flash drivers
3013 (e.g. CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER or CONFIG_ST_SMI) must be
3014 selected or the board must provide an implementation of the
3015 flash API (see include/flash.h).
3016
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003017- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00003018 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
3019
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003020 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
3021 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
3022 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00003023
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07003024- Serial Flash support
3025 CONFIG_CMD_SF
3026
3027 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
3028 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
3029
3030 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
3031 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
3032 commands.
3033
3034 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
3035 to handle the common case when only a single serial
3036 flash is present on the system.
3037
3038 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
3039 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
3040 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
3041 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
3042
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00003043 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
3044
3045 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
3046 test ('sf test').
3047
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05303048 CONFIG_SF_DUAL_FLASH Dual flash memories
3049
3050 Define this option to use dual flash support where two flash
3051 memories can be connected with a given cs line.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003052 Currently Xilinx Zynq qspi supports these type of connections.
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekib902e072014-01-11 15:25:04 +05303053
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003054- SystemACE Support:
3055 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
3056
3057 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
3058 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003059 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003060 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003061
3062 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003063 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00003064
3065 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
3066 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
3067
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003068- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
3069 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
3070
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003071 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003072 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003073 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003074 number generator is used.
3075
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02003076 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
3077 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
3078 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
3079
3080 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02003081 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
3082 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
3083 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
3084 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
3085 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
3086 but sometimes that is not allowed.
3087
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003088- Hashing support:
3089 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
3090
3091 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
3092 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
3093
3094 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
3095
3096 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
3097 size a little.
3098
gaurav rana94e3c8c2015-02-20 12:51:46 +05303099 CONFIG_SHA1 - This option enables support of hashing using SHA1
3100 algorithm. The hash is calculated in software.
3101 CONFIG_SHA256 - This option enables support of hashing using
3102 SHA256 algorithm. The hash is calculated in software.
3103 CONFIG_SHA_HW_ACCEL - This option enables hardware acceleration
3104 for SHA1/SHA256 hashing.
3105 This affects the 'hash' command and also the
3106 hash_lookup_algo() function.
3107 CONFIG_SHA_PROG_HW_ACCEL - This option enables
3108 hardware-acceleration for SHA1/SHA256 progressive hashing.
3109 Data can be streamed in a block at a time and the hashing
3110 is performed in hardware.
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00003111
3112 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
3113 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
3114
Robert Winklera11f1872013-07-24 17:57:06 -07003115- Freescale i.MX specific commands:
3116 CONFIG_CMD_HDMIDETECT
3117 This enables 'hdmidet' command which returns true if an
3118 HDMI monitor is detected. This command is i.MX 6 specific.
3119
3120 CONFIG_CMD_BMODE
3121 This enables the 'bmode' (bootmode) command for forcing
3122 a boot from specific media.
3123
3124 This is useful for forcing the ROM's usb downloader to
3125 activate upon a watchdog reset which is nice when iterating
3126 on U-Boot. Using the reset button or running bmode normal
3127 will set it back to normal. This command currently
3128 supports i.MX53 and i.MX6.
3129
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003130- Signing support:
3131 CONFIG_RSA
3132
3133 This enables the RSA algorithm used for FIT image verification
Detlev Zundel8bf2aad2014-01-20 16:21:46 +01003134 in U-Boot. See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more information.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003135
Ruchika Guptac937ff62015-01-23 16:01:54 +05303136 The Modular Exponentiation algorithm in RSA is implemented using
3137 driver model. So CONFIG_DM needs to be enabled by default for this
3138 library to function.
3139
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003140 The signing part is build into mkimage regardless of this
Ruchika Guptac937ff62015-01-23 16:01:54 +05303141 option. The software based modular exponentiation is built into
3142 mkimage irrespective of this option.
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003143
Heiko Schocher9e50c402014-01-25 07:27:13 +01003144- bootcount support:
3145 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
3146
3147 This enables the bootcounter support, see:
3148 http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
3149
3150 CONFIG_AT91SAM9XE
3151 enable special bootcounter support on at91sam9xe based boards.
3152 CONFIG_BLACKFIN
3153 enable special bootcounter support on blackfin based boards.
3154 CONFIG_SOC_DA8XX
3155 enable special bootcounter support on da850 based boards.
3156 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_RAM
3157 enable support for the bootcounter in RAM
3158 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_I2C
3159 enable support for the bootcounter on an i2c (like RTC) device.
3160 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RTC_ADDR = i2c chip address
3161 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTCOUNT_ADDR = i2c addr which is used for
3162 the bootcounter.
3163 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ALEN = address len
Simon Glass19c402a2013-06-13 15:10:02 -07003164
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003165- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003166 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
3167
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003168 Defining this option allows to add some board-
3169 specific code (calling a user-provided function
3170 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
3171 the system's boot progress on some display (for
3172 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
3173 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003174
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00003175
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003176Legacy uImage format:
3177
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003178 Arg Where When
3179 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003180 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003181 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003182 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003183 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003184 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003185 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
3186 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
3187 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003188 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003189 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
3190 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
3191 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
3192 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003193 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003194 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003195
3196 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3197 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
3198 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
3199 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
3200 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
3201 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
3202 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003203 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003204 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
3205 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
3206
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003207 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003208
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003209 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00003210 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
3211 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00003212
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003213 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
3214 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
3215 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
3216 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
3217 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
3218 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3219 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
3220 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
3221 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
3222 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
3223 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3224 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
3225 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
3226 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
3227 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
3228 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
3229 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
3230 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
3231 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
3232 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
3233 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
3234 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
3235 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
3236 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
3237 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
3238 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
3239 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3240 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
3241 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
3242 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
3243 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
3244 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
3245 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
3246 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
3247 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
3248 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
3249 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
3250 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
3251 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
3252 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
3253 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
3254 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
3255 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
3256 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
3257 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
3258 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
3259 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003260
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003261 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003262
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003263 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003264 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
3265 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00003266
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003267 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
Joe Hershbergerbc0571f2015-04-08 01:41:21 -05003268 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling net_loop()
3269 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in net_loop() occurred
3270 81 common/cmd_net.c net_loop() back without error
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003271 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
3272 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02003273 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
3274 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003275 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003276
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003277FIT uImage format:
3278
3279 Arg Where When
3280 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
3281 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
3282 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
3283 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
3284 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
3285 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01003286 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003287 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
3288 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
3289 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
3290 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
3291 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003292 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
3293 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003294 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
3295 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
3296 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
3297 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
3298 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
3299 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
3300 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
3301 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
3302
3303 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3304 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
3305 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003306 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003307 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
3308 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
3309 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
3310 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
3311 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
3312 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
3313 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
3314 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
3315 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
3316 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
3317 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
3318 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
3319
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003320 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003321 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
3322
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003323 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003324 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
3325
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003326 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003327 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
3328
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003329- legacy image format:
3330 CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3331 enables the legacy image format support in U-Boot.
3332
3333 Default:
3334 enabled if CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE is not defined.
3335
3336 CONFIG_DISABLE_IMAGE_LEGACY
3337 disable the legacy image format
3338
3339 This define is introduced, as the legacy image format is
3340 enabled per default for backward compatibility.
3341
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00003342- FIT image support:
3343 CONFIG_FIT
3344 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
3345
3346 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
3347 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
3348 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
3349 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
3350 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
3351 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
3352
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003353 CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE
3354 This option enables signature verification of FIT uImages,
gaurav rana94e3c8c2015-02-20 12:51:46 +05303355 using a hash signed and verified using RSA. If
3356 CONFIG_SHA_PROG_HW_ACCEL is defined, i.e support for progressive
3357 hashing is available using hardware, RSA library will use it.
3358 See doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more details.
Simon Glass3e569a62013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003359
Heiko Schocher21d29f72014-05-28 11:33:33 +02003360 WARNING: When relying on signed FIT images with required
3361 signature check the legacy image format is default
3362 disabled. If a board need legacy image format support
3363 enable this through CONFIG_IMAGE_FORMAT_LEGACY
3364
Dirk Eibach9a4f4792014-07-03 09:28:26 +02003365 CONFIG_FIT_DISABLE_SHA256
3366 Supporting SHA256 hashes has quite an impact on binary size.
3367 For constrained systems sha256 hash support can be disabled
3368 with this option.
3369
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003370- Standalone program support:
3371 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
3372
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02003373 This option defines a board specific value for the
3374 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
3375 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003376 settings.
3377
3378- Frame Buffer Address:
3379 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
3380
3381 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00003382 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
3383 when using a graphics controller has separate video
3384 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
3385 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
3386 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
3387 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
3388 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003389
3390 Please see board_init_f function.
3391
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01003392- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
3393 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
3394 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
3395 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
3396
3397 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
3398 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
3399
3400- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
3401 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
3402
3403 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
3404 Needed for mtdparts command support.
3405
3406 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
3407
3408 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
3409 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
3410
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003411- UBI support
3412 CONFIG_CMD_UBI
3413
3414 Adds commands for interacting with MTD partitions formatted
3415 with the UBI flash translation layer
3416
3417 Requires also defining CONFIG_RBTREE
3418
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003419 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3420
3421 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
3422 warnings and errors enabled.
3423
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003424
3425 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_WL_THRESHOLD
3426 This parameter defines the maximum difference between the highest
3427 erase counter value and the lowest erase counter value of eraseblocks
3428 of UBI devices. When this threshold is exceeded, UBI starts performing
3429 wear leveling by means of moving data from eraseblock with low erase
3430 counter to eraseblocks with high erase counter.
3431
3432 The default value should be OK for SLC NAND flashes, NOR flashes and
3433 other flashes which have eraseblock life-cycle 100000 or more.
3434 However, in case of MLC NAND flashes which typically have eraseblock
3435 life-cycle less than 10000, the threshold should be lessened (e.g.,
3436 to 128 or 256, although it does not have to be power of 2).
3437
3438 default: 4096
Simon Glassc654b512014-10-23 18:58:54 -06003439
Heiko Schocherff94bc42014-06-24 10:10:04 +02003440 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_BEB_LIMIT
3441 This option specifies the maximum bad physical eraseblocks UBI
3442 expects on the MTD device (per 1024 eraseblocks). If the
3443 underlying flash does not admit of bad eraseblocks (e.g. NOR
3444 flash), this value is ignored.
3445
3446 NAND datasheets often specify the minimum and maximum NVM
3447 (Number of Valid Blocks) for the flashes' endurance lifetime.
3448 The maximum expected bad eraseblocks per 1024 eraseblocks
3449 then can be calculated as "1024 * (1 - MinNVB / MaxNVB)",
3450 which gives 20 for most NANDs (MaxNVB is basically the total
3451 count of eraseblocks on the chip).
3452
3453 To put it differently, if this value is 20, UBI will try to
3454 reserve about 1.9% of physical eraseblocks for bad blocks
3455 handling. And that will be 1.9% of eraseblocks on the entire
3456 NAND chip, not just the MTD partition UBI attaches. This means
3457 that if you have, say, a NAND flash chip admits maximum 40 bad
3458 eraseblocks, and it is split on two MTD partitions of the same
3459 size, UBI will reserve 40 eraseblocks when attaching a
3460 partition.
3461
3462 default: 20
3463
3464 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP
3465 Fastmap is a mechanism which allows attaching an UBI device
3466 in nearly constant time. Instead of scanning the whole MTD device it
3467 only has to locate a checkpoint (called fastmap) on the device.
3468 The on-flash fastmap contains all information needed to attach
3469 the device. Using fastmap makes only sense on large devices where
3470 attaching by scanning takes long. UBI will not automatically install
3471 a fastmap on old images, but you can set the UBI parameter
3472 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT to 1 if you want so. Please note
3473 that fastmap-enabled images are still usable with UBI implementations
3474 without fastmap support. On typical flash devices the whole fastmap
3475 fits into one PEB. UBI will reserve PEBs to hold two fastmaps.
3476
3477 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FASTMAP_AUTOCONVERT
3478 Set this parameter to enable fastmap automatically on images
3479 without a fastmap.
3480 default: 0
3481
Heiko Schocher0195a7b2015-10-22 06:19:21 +02003482 CONFIG_MTD_UBI_FM_DEBUG
3483 Enable UBI fastmap debug
3484 default: 0
3485
Joe Hershberger70c219c2013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003486- UBIFS support
3487 CONFIG_CMD_UBIFS
3488
3489 Adds commands for interacting with UBI volumes formatted as
3490 UBIFS. UBIFS is read-only in u-boot.
3491
3492 Requires UBI support as well as CONFIG_LZO
3493
Joe Hershberger147162d2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003494 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3495
3496 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
3497 warnings and errors enabled.
3498
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003499- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003500 CONFIG_SPL
3501 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003502
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003503 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
3504 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
3505
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003506 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
3507 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
3508 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
3509 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003510 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003511 must not be both defined at the same time.
3512
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003513 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003514 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
3515 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
3516 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
3517 not exceed it.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003518
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003519 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
3520 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003521
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003522 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
3523 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
3524 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
3525
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003526 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
3527 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
3528
3529 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003530 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
3531 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
3532 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUD8960af82013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003533 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUD6ebc3462013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003534 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003535
3536 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
3537 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
3538
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)8c80eb32015-03-31 11:40:50 +02003539 CONFIG_SPL_PANIC_ON_RAW_IMAGE
3540 When defined, SPL will panic() if the image it has
3541 loaded does not have a signature.
3542 Defining this is useful when code which loads images
3543 in SPL cannot guarantee that absolutely all read errors
3544 will be caught.
3545 An example is the LPC32XX MLC NAND driver, which will
3546 consider that a completely unreadable NAND block is bad,
3547 and thus should be skipped silently.
3548
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003549 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
3550 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
3551 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
3552 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
3553
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003554 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
3555 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Fabio Estevam9ac4fc82015-11-12 12:30:19 -02003556 When this option is set the full malloc is used in SPL and
3557 it is set up by spl_init() and before that, the simple malloc()
3558 can be used if CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F is defined.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003559
3560 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
3561 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003562
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07003563 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
3564 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
3565 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
3566 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
3567
Tom Rini9607faf2014-03-28 12:03:39 -04003568 CONFIG_SPL_OS_BOOT
3569 Enable booting directly to an OS from SPL.
3570 See also: doc/README.falcon
3571
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07003572 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
3573 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
3574 about the running system.
3575
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05003576 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
3577 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
3578
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003579 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
3580 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003581
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003582 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
3583 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003584
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003585 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
3586 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003587
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003588 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
3589 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003590
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003591 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
3592 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003593
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003594 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
3595 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
Paul Kocialkowskie2ccdf82014-11-08 23:14:55 +01003596 Address and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003597 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
3598
Paul Kocialkowskib97300b2014-11-08 23:14:56 +01003599 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_PARTITION
3600 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
3601 used in raw mode
3602
Peter Korsgaard2b75b0a2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00003603 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
3604 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
3605 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
3606
3607 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
3608 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
3609 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
3610 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
3611 (for falcon mode)
3612
Paul Kocialkowskie2ccdf82014-11-08 23:14:55 +01003613 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_FS_BOOT_PARTITION
3614 Partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from when the MMC is being
3615 used in fs mode
3616
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003617 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
3618 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
3619
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003620 CONFIG_SPL_EXT_SUPPORT
3621 Support for EXT filesystem in SPL binary
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003622
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003623 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
3624 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from filesystem
3625
3626 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003627 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003628 from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003629
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003630 CONFIG_SPL_FS_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003631 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
Guillaume GARDETfae81c72014-10-15 17:53:13 +02003632 when reading from filesystem (for Falcon mode)
Peter Korsgaard7ad2cc72013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003633
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00003634 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
3635 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
3636 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
3637 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
3638 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
3639
Prabhakar Kushwaha651fcf62014-04-08 19:12:31 +05303640 CONFIG_SPL_SKIP_RELOCATE
3641 Avoid SPL relocation
3642
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05003643 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
3644 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
3645 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
3646
3647 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
3648 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
3649
3650 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
3651 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
3652
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003653 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003654 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
3655 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003656
Tom Rini6dd3b562014-03-28 12:03:36 -04003657 CONFIG_SPL_MTD_SUPPORT
3658 Support for the MTD subsystem within SPL. Useful for
3659 environment on NAND support within SPL.
3660
Heiko Schocher0c3117b2014-10-31 08:31:00 +01003661 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_RAW_ONLY
3662 Support to boot only raw u-boot.bin images. Use this only
3663 if you need to save space.
3664
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003665 CONFIG_SPL_MPC8XXX_INIT_DDR_SUPPORT
3666 Set for the SPL on PPC mpc8xxx targets, support for
York Sun5614e712013-09-30 09:22:09 -07003667 drivers/ddr/fsl/libddr.o in SPL binary.
Ying Zhangbb0dc102013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003668
Ying Zhang7c8eea52013-08-16 15:16:12 +08003669 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
3670 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
3671 SPL binary.
3672
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003673 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
3674 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
3675 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
3676 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
3677 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
3678 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003679 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003680
Prabhakar Kushwahafbe76ae2013-12-11 12:42:11 +05303681 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
3682 Add support NAND boot
3683
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003684 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003685 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
3686
3687 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
3688 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
3689
3690 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
3691 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003692
3693 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003694 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003695
3696 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
3697 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003698 data. This is used, for example, on davinci platforms.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003699
3700 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
3701 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
3702 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
3703
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003704 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
3705 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003706
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003707 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
3708 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003709
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003710 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
3711 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003712
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02003713 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
3714 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
3715
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003716 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
3717 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003718
Ying Zhangba1bee42013-05-20 14:07:25 +08003719 CONFIG_SPL_ENV_SUPPORT
3720 Support for the environment operating in SPL binary
3721
3722 CONFIG_SPL_NET_SUPPORT
3723 Support for the net/libnet.o in SPL binary.
3724 It conflicts with SPL env from storage medium specified by
3725 CONFIG_ENV_IS_xxx but CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
3726
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003727 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeau6113d3f2013-04-11 09:35:49 +00003728 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
3729 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
3730 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3731 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3732 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003733
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05003734 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
3735 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
3736 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
3737 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
3738
Simon Glass87ebee32013-05-08 08:05:59 +00003739 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
3740 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
3741 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
3742 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
3743 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
3744
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003745- TPL framework
3746 CONFIG_TPL
3747 Enable building of TPL globally.
3748
3749 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
3750 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
3751 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denk93e14592013-10-04 17:43:24 +02003752 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3753 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3754 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003755
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003756Modem Support:
3757--------------
3758
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02003759[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003760
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003761- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003762 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
3763
3764- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
3765 CONFIG_HWFLOW
3766
3767- Modem debug support:
3768 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
3769
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003770 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
3771 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003772
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003773- Interrupt support (PPC):
3774
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003775 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
3776 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003777 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003778 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003779 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003780 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003781 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003782 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
3783 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
3784 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003785
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003786- General:
3787
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003788 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
3789 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
3790 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003791 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003792 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
3793 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
3794 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003795
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003796 If there are no modem init strings in the
3797 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
3798 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003799 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003800
3801 See also: doc/README.Modem
3802
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003803Board initialization settings:
3804------------------------------
3805
3806During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3807to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3808before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3809following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3810architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3811typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3812
3813- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3814- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3815- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3816- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003817
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003818Configuration Settings:
3819-----------------------
3820
York Sun4d1fd7f2014-02-26 17:03:19 -08003821- CONFIG_SYS_SUPPORT_64BIT_DATA: Defined automatically if compiled as 64-bit.
3822 Optionally it can be defined to support 64-bit memory commands.
3823
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003824- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003825 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3826
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003827- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3828 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3829
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003830- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003831 prompt for user input.
3832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003833- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003834
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003835- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003836
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003837- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003838
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003839- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003840 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3841 booted
3842
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003843- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003844 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3845
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003846- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003847 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003848
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003849- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003850 If the board specific function
3851 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3852 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003853 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3854
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003855- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003856 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003857
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003858- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003859 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3860
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003861- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003862 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3863 simple memory test.
3864
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003865- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003866 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003867
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003868- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003869 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3870 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3871
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003872- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3873 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003874 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003875 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003876 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3877 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3878 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003879 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003880 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003881 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003882
3883 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3884 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3885 be touched.
3886
3887 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3888 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3889 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3890 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3891 problems.
3892
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003893- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003894 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3895
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003896- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003897 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3898
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003899- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003900 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3901 Cogent motherboard)
3902
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003903- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003904 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3905
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003906- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003907 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3908 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003909 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003910 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003911
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003912- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003913 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3914 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3915 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3916 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003917
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003918- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003919 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3920
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003921- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_F_LEN
3922 Size of the malloc() pool for use before relocation. If
3923 this is defined, then a very simple malloc() implementation
3924 will become available before relocation. The address is just
3925 below the global data, and the stack is moved down to make
3926 space.
3927
3928 This feature allocates regions with increasing addresses
3929 within the region. calloc() is supported, but realloc()
3930 is not available. free() is supported but does nothing.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08003931 The memory will be freed (or in fact just forgotten) when
Simon Glassd59476b2014-07-10 22:23:28 -06003932 U-Boot relocates itself.
3933
Simon Glasse7b14e92014-09-15 06:33:18 -06003934 Pre-relocation malloc() is only supported on ARM and sandbox
Simon Glass29afe9e2014-07-10 22:23:31 -06003935 at present but is fairly easy to enable for other archs.
3936
Simon Glass38687ae2014-11-10 17:16:54 -07003937- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_SIMPLE
3938 Provides a simple and small malloc() and calloc() for those
3939 boards which do not use the full malloc in SPL (which is
3940 enabled with CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START).
3941
Thierry Reding1dfdd9b2014-12-09 22:25:22 -07003942- CONFIG_SYS_NONCACHED_MEMORY:
3943 Size of non-cached memory area. This area of memory will be
3944 typically located right below the malloc() area and mapped
3945 uncached in the MMU. This is useful for drivers that would
3946 otherwise require a lot of explicit cache maintenance. For
3947 some drivers it's also impossible to properly maintain the
3948 cache. For example if the regions that need to be flushed
3949 are not a multiple of the cache-line size, *and* padding
3950 cannot be allocated between the regions to align them (i.e.
3951 if the HW requires a contiguous array of regions, and the
3952 size of each region is not cache-aligned), then a flush of
3953 one region may result in overwriting data that hardware has
3954 written to another region in the same cache-line. This can
3955 happen for example in network drivers where descriptors for
3956 buffers are typically smaller than the CPU cache-line (e.g.
3957 16 bytes vs. 32 or 64 bytes).
3958
3959 Non-cached memory is only supported on 32-bit ARM at present.
3960
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003961- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003962 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3963 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003964 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003965 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3966
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003967- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003968 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3969 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003970 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3971 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003972 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003973 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003974 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003975 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3976 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3977 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003978
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003979- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3980 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3981 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3982 is enabled.
3983
3984- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3985 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3986 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3987
3988- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3989 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3990 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3991
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003992- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003993 Max number of Flash memory banks
3994
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003995- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003996 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3997
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003998- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003999 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
4000
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004001- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004002 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
4003
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004004- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004005 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
4006
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004007- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004008 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
4009
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004010- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00004011 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
4012 instead of U-Boot software protection.
4013
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004014- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004015
4016 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
4017 without this option such a download has to be
4018 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
4019 copy from RAM to flash.
4020
4021 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
4022 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004023 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
4024 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004025 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
4026
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004027- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004028 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00004029 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
4030
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02004031- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00004032 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
4033 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004034
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01004035- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
4036 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
4037 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
4038 to the MTD layer.
4039
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004040- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02004041 Use buffered writes to flash.
4042
4043- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
4044 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
4045 write commands.
4046
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004047- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01004048 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
4049 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
4050 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
4051 optionally available.
4052
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05004053- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
4054 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
4055 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
4056 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
4057
Stefan Roese352ef3f2013-04-04 15:53:14 +02004058- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
4059 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
4060 against the source after the write operation. An error message
4061 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
4062 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
4063 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
4064 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
4065 this option if you really know what you are doing.
4066
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004067- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004068 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
4069 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00004070 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
4071 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004072 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00004073 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
4074
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02004075- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
4076
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02004077 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
4078 internally to store the environment settings. The default
4079 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
4080 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
4081 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02004082
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004083- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4084- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day1bce2ae2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04004085 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004086 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
4087 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
4088 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
4089
4090 The format of the list is:
4091 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004092 access_attribute = [a|r|o|c]
4093 attributes = type_attribute[access_attribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004094 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
4095 list = entry[,list]
4096
4097 The type attributes are:
4098 s - String (default)
4099 d - Decimal
4100 x - Hexadecimal
4101 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
4102 i - IP address
4103 m - MAC address
4104
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004105 The access attributes are:
4106 a - Any (default)
4107 r - Read-only
4108 o - Write-once
4109 c - Change-default
4110
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004111 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
4112 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004113 environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06004114
4115 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
4116 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
4117 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
4118 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
4119 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
4120 ".flags" variable.
4121
Joe Hershbergerbdf1fe42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05004122 If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
4123 regular expression. This allows multiple variables to define the same
4124 flags without explicitly listing them for each variable.
4125
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06004126- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
4127 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
4128 access flags.
4129
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004130- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
4131 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
4132 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
4133 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
4134 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
4135 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
Masahiro Yamada0a12e682015-03-19 19:42:51 +09004136 must support it (i.e. must select HAVE_GENERIC_BOARD in arch/Kconfig).
4137 If you find problems enabling this option on your board please report
4138 the problem and send patches!
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00004139
Lokesh Vutla0b1b60c2013-04-17 20:49:40 +00004140- CONFIG_OMAP_PLATFORM_RESET_TIME_MAX_USEC (OMAP only)
4141 This is set by OMAP boards for the max time that reset should
4142 be asserted. See doc/README.omap-reset-time for details on how
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004143 the value can be calculated on a given board.
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00004144
Gabe Black0d296cc2014-10-15 04:38:30 -06004145- CONFIG_USE_STDINT
4146 If stdint.h is available with your toolchain you can define this
4147 option to enable it. You can provide option 'USE_STDINT=1' when
4148 building U-Boot to enable this.
4149
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004150The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
4151of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
4152following configurations:
4153
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00004154- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
4155
4156 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
4157 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
4158
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004159- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004160
4161 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
4162
4163 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
4164 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
4165 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
4166 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
4167 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
4168 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
4169 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
4170 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
4171 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
4172 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
4173 between U-Boot and the environment.
4174
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004175 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004176
4177 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
4178 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
4179 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
4180 for this sector is given here.
4181
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004182 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004183
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004184 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004185
4186 This is just another way to specify the start address of
4187 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004188 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004189
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004190 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004191
4192 Size of the sector containing the environment.
4193
4194
4195 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
4196 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
4197 the environment.
4198
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004199 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004200
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02004201 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004202 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004203 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
4204 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
4205
4206 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
4207 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
4208 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
4209 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
4210 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
4211 updating the environment in flash makes it always
4212 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
4213 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
4214 RAM, your target system will be dead.
4215
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004216 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
4217 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004218
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004219 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004220 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00004221 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004222 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004223
4224BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
4225source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
4226accordingly!
4227
4228
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02004229- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004230
4231 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
4232 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
4233 environment.
4234
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004235 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4236 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004237
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004238 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004239 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
4240 can just be read and written to, without any special
4241 provision.
4242
4243BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004244in U-Boot initialization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004245console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004246U-Boot will hang.
4247
4248Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
4249environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
4250keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
4251to save the current settings.
4252
4253
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02004254- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004255
4256 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
4257 device and a driver for it.
4258
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004259 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4260 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004261
4262 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4263 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
4264
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004265 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004266 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
4267 The default address is zero.
4268
Christian Gmeiner189d2572015-02-11 15:19:31 +01004269 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_BUS:
4270 If defined, specified the i2c bus of the EEPROM device.
4271
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004272 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004273 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
4274 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
4275 would require six bits.
4276
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004277 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004278 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00004279 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004280
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004281 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004282 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
4283 that this is NOT the chip address length!
4284
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004285 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004286 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
4287 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
4288 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
4289 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
4290 byte chips.
4291
4292 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
4293 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
4294 in the chip address.
4295
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004296 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004297 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
4298
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004299 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
4300 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
4301 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
4302
4303 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
4304 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
4305 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
4306 EEPROM. For example:
4307
Heiko Schocherea818db2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01004308 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS 1
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01004309
4310 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
4311 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004312
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004313- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004314
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00004315 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004316 want to use for the environment.
4317
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004318 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4319 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4320 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004321
4322 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
4323 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
4324 at the specified address.
4325
Wu, Joshbd83b592014-07-01 19:30:13 +08004326- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_SPI_FLASH:
4327
4328 Define this if you have a SPI Flash memory device which you
4329 want to use for the environment.
4330
4331 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4332 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4333
4334 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
4335 environment area within the SPI Flash. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4336 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4337
4338 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
4339
4340 Define the SPI flash's sector size.
4341
4342 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4343
4344 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
4345 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4346 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
4347 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
4348 aligned to an erase sector boundary.
4349
4350 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_BUS (optional):
4351 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_CS (optional):
4352
4353 Define the SPI bus and chip select. If not defined they will be 0.
4354
4355 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MAX_HZ (optional):
4356
4357 Define the SPI max work clock. If not defined then use 1MHz.
4358
4359 - CONFIG_ENV_SPI_MODE (optional):
4360
4361 Define the SPI work mode. If not defined then use SPI_MODE_3.
4362
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004363- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
4364
4365 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
4366 want to use for the local device's environment.
4367
4368 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
4369 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4370
4371 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
4372 environment area within the remote memory space. The
4373 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004374 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004375
4376BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
4377"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004378environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
4379but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00004380
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02004381- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004382
4383 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
4384 for the environment.
4385
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004386 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4387 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00004388
4389 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004390 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
4391 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00004392
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004393 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004394
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02004395 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004396 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
4397 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004398 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004399 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004400
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05004401 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
4402
4403 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
4404 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
4405 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
4406 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
4407 the range to be avoided.
4408
4409 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
4410
4411 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
4412 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
4413 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
4414 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
4415 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01004416
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02004417- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
4418
4419 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
4420 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
4421 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4422
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004423- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_UBI:
4424
4425 Define this if you have an UBI volume that you want to use for the
4426 environment. This has the benefit of wear-leveling the environment
4427 accesses, which is important on NAND.
4428
4429 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_PART:
4430
4431 Define this to a string that is the mtd partition containing the UBI.
4432
4433 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME:
4434
4435 Define this to the name of the volume that you want to store the
4436 environment in.
4437
Joe Hershberger785881f2013-04-08 10:32:52 +00004438 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME_REDUND:
4439
4440 Define this to the name of another volume to store a second copy of
4441 the environment in. This will enable redundant environments in UBI.
4442 It is assumed that both volumes are in the same MTD partition.
4443
Joe Hershberger2b744332013-04-08 10:32:51 +00004444 - CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
4445 - CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
4446
4447 You will probably want to define these to avoid a really noisy system
4448 when storing the env in UBI.
4449
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004450- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FAT:
4451 Define this if you want to use the FAT file system for the environment.
4452
4453 - FAT_ENV_INTERFACE:
4454
4455 Define this to a string that is the name of the block device.
4456
4457 - FAT_ENV_DEV_AND_PART:
4458
4459 Define this to a string to specify the partition of the device. It can
4460 be as following:
4461
4462 "D:P", "D:0", "D", "D:" or "D:auto" (D, P are integers. And P >= 1)
4463 - "D:P": device D partition P. Error occurs if device D has no
4464 partition table.
4465 - "D:0": device D.
4466 - "D" or "D:": device D partition 1 if device D has partition
4467 table, or the whole device D if has no partition
4468 table.
4469 - "D:auto": first partition in device D with bootable flag set.
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004470 If none, first valid partition in device D. If no
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004471 partition table then means device D.
4472
4473 - FAT_ENV_FILE:
4474
4475 It's a string of the FAT file name. This file use to store the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004476 environment.
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004477
4478 - CONFIG_FAT_WRITE:
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004479 This should be defined. Otherwise it cannot save the environment file.
Wu, Joshd1db76f2014-06-24 17:31:03 +08004480
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004481- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC:
4482
4483 Define this if you have an MMC device which you want to use for the
4484 environment.
4485
4486 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV:
4487
4488 Specifies which MMC device the environment is stored in.
4489
4490 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART (optional):
4491
4492 Specifies which MMC partition the environment is stored in. If not
4493 set, defaults to partition 0, the user area. Common values might be
4494 1 (first MMC boot partition), 2 (second MMC boot partition).
4495
4496 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
4497 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
4498
4499 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
4500 area within the specified MMC device.
4501
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004502 If offset is positive (the usual case), it is treated as relative to
4503 the start of the MMC partition. If offset is negative, it is treated
4504 as relative to the end of the MMC partition. This can be useful if
4505 your board may be fitted with different MMC devices, which have
4506 different sizes for the MMC partitions, and you always want the
4507 environment placed at the very end of the partition, to leave the
4508 maximum possible space before it, to store other data.
4509
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004510 These two values are in units of bytes, but must be aligned to an
4511 MMC sector boundary.
4512
4513 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4514
4515 Specifies a second storage area, of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE size, used to
4516 hold a redundant copy of the environment data. This provides a
4517 valid backup copy in case the other copy is corrupted, e.g. due
4518 to a power failure during a "saveenv" operation.
4519
Stephen Warren5c088ee2013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004520 This value may also be positive or negative; this is handled in the
4521 same way as CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET.
4522
Stephen Warren06e4ae52013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004523 This value is also in units of bytes, but must also be aligned to
4524 an MMC sector boundary.
4525
4526 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND (optional):
4527
4528 This value need not be set, even when CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is
4529 set. If this value is set, it must be set to the same value as
4530 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4531
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004532- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004533
4534 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
4535 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
4536 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
4537 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
4538 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
4539 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
4540 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
4541
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07004542Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004543has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02004544created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004545until then to read environment variables.
4546
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004547The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
4548is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
4549with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
4550necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
4551"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
4552have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004553
4554Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
4555the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004556use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004557
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004558- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004559 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004560
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004561 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004562 also needs to be defined.
4563
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004564- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004565 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004566
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08004567- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
4568 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
4569 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
4570 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
4571 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
4572 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
4573
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00004574- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
4575 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
4576 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
4577 to do this.
4578
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00004579- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
4580 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
4581 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
4582 present.
4583
Sascha Silbefeb85802013-08-11 16:40:43 +02004584- CONFIG_BOARD_SIZE_LIMIT:
4585 Maximum size of the U-Boot image. When defined, the
4586 build system checks that the actual size does not
4587 exceed it.
4588
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004589Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00004590---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004591
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004592- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004593 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
4594
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004595- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004596 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00004597
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004598 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
4599 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
4600 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004601
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004602- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
4603 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
4604 PowerPC SOCs.
4605
4606- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
4607 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
4608 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
4609
4610 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
4611 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
4612
4613- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
4614 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
4615 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004616 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004617 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
4618 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
4619 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
4620
4621 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
4622 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
4623
4624- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02004625 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
4626 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004627 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4628 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4629
4630- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
4631 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
4632 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4633 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4634
4635- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
4636 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
4637 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
4638
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004639- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004640 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004641
4642 the default drive number (default value 0)
4643
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004644 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004645
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004646 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004647 (default value 1)
4648
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004649 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004650
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004651 defines the offset of register from address. It
4652 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004653 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004654
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004655 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
4656 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004657 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004658
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004659 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004660 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
4661 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004662 source code. It is used to make hardware-dependent
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004663 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004664
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004665- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
4666 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
4667 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
4668 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
4669 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
4670 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004671 is required.
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004672
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004673- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004674 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00004675 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004676
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004677- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004678
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00004679 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004680 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
4681 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
4682 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
4683 will become available only after programming the
4684 memory controller and running certain initialization
4685 sequences.
4686
4687 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
4688 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
4689 - MPC824X: data cache
4690 - PPC4xx: data cache
4691
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004692- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004693
4694 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004695 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
4696 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004697 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02004698 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004699 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
4700 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
4701 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004702
4703 Note:
4704 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
4705 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004706 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004707 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
4708 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
4709
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004710- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004711
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004712- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004713
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004714- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004715
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004716- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004717
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004718- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004719
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004720- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004721
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004722- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004723 SDRAM timing
4724
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004725- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004726 periodic timer for refresh
4727
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004728- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004729
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004730- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
4731 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
4732 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
4733 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004734 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
4735
4736- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004737 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
4738 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004739 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
4740
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004741- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
4742 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004743 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
4744 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
4745
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004746- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004747 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4748 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
4749
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004750- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01004751 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4752 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
4753
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004754- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004755 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4756 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
4757
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004758- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004759 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
4760 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
4761 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
4762
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004763- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004764 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
4765 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
4766 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
4767 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00004768
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004769- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4770 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
4771 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
4772 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4773 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
4774 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
4775 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
4776 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004777 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00004778
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01004779- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
4780 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
4781 required.
4782
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004783- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08004784 Only scan through and get the devices on the buses.
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004785 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
4786 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
4787 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
4788 by coreboot or similar.
4789
Gabor Juhos842033e2013-05-30 07:06:12 +00004790- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
4791 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
4792
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004793- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
4794 Chip has SRIO or not
4795
4796- CONFIG_SRIO1:
4797 Board has SRIO 1 port available
4798
4799- CONFIG_SRIO2:
4800 Board has SRIO 2 port available
4801
Liu Gangc8b28152013-05-07 16:30:46 +08004802- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
4803 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
4804
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004805- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
4806 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4807
4808- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
4809 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4810
4811- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
4812 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4813
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004814- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
4815 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
4816 a 16 bit bus.
4817 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004818 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevam66bd1842013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004819 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevama430e912013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004820 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04004821
4822- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
4823 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
4824 a default value will be used.
4825
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004826- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004827 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
4828 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
4829
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004830 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
4831 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
4832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004833- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004834 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
4835 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
4836 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004837
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08004838- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
4839 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
4840 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
4841 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
4842 header files or board specific files.
4843
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07004844- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
4845 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
4846
York Sune32d59a2015-01-06 13:18:55 -08004847- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_SYNC_REFRESH
4848 Enable sync of refresh for multiple controllers.
4849
York Sun4516ff82015-03-19 09:30:28 -07004850- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_BIST
4851 Enable built-in memory test for Freescale DDR controllers.
4852
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004853- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004854 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
4855 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06004856
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004857- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
4858 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
4859
4860- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
4861 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00004862 to the given FEC; i. e.
4863 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004864 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
4865
4866 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
4867
4868- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
4869 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
4870 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
4871
4872- CONFIG_RMII
4873 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
4874 Note that this is a global option, we can't
4875 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
4876
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004877- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
4878 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
4879 The syntax is:
4880
4881 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
4882
4883 Where address/count indicate a memory area
4884 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
4885 area should have.
4886
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004887- CONFIG_LOOPW
4888 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004889 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004890
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004891- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
4892 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
4893 "md/mw" commands.
4894 Examples:
4895
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004896 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004897 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
4898
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004899 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004900 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
4901
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004902 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004903 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004904
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004905- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004906 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004907 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
4908 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
4909 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004910
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004911 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
4912 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
4913 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
4914 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004915
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00004916- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02004917 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4918 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
4919 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00004920
Ying Zhang3aa29de2013-08-16 15:16:15 +08004921- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
4922 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4923 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
4924 It is loaded by the SPL.
4925
Ying Zhang5df572f2013-05-20 14:07:23 +08004926- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
4927 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
4928 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
4929 previous 4k of the .text section.
4930
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00004931- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
4932 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
4933 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
4934 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
4935 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
4936 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
4937 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
4938 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
4939
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00004940- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
4941 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
4942 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
4943 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
4944 conditions but may increase the binary size.
4945
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00004946- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
4947 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
4948 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00004949
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00004950- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
4951 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
4952
4953 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00004954
Heiko Schocher16678eb2013-11-04 14:05:00 +01004955- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
4956 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
4957
Karicheri, Muralidharan999d7d32014-04-04 13:16:50 -04004958- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_NO_SUBPAGE_WRITE
4959 Option to disable subpage write in NAND driver
4960 driver that uses this:
4961 drivers/mtd/nand/davinci_nand.c
4962
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004963Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
4964-----------------------------------
4965
4966The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
4967loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
4968This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4969are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4970within that device.
4971
Zhao Qiangdcf1d772014-03-21 16:21:44 +08004972- CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR
4973 The address in the storage device where the FMAN microcode is located. The
4974 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4975 is also specified.
4976
4977- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_ADDR
4978 The address in the storage device where the QE microcode is located. The
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004979 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4980 is also specified.
4981
4982- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
4983 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4984 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4985 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4986 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4987
4988- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
4989 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4990 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
4991 virtual address in NOR flash.
4992
4993- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
4994 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
4995 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
4996
4997- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
4998 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
4999 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
5000
5001- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
5002 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
5003 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
5004
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00005005- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
5006 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
5007 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00005008 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
5009 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
5010 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06005011
J. German Riverab940ca62014-06-23 15:15:55 -07005012Freescale Layerscape Management Complex Firmware Support:
5013---------------------------------------------------------
5014The Freescale Layerscape Management Complex (MC) supports the loading of
5015"firmware".
5016This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
5017are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
5018within that device.
5019
5020- CONFIG_FSL_MC_ENET
5021 Enable the MC driver for Layerscape SoCs.
5022
5023- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR
5024 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
5025 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_xxx macro
5026 is also specified.
5027
5028- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_LENGTH
5029 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
5030 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
5031 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
5032 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
5033
5034- CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_IN_NOR
5035 Specifies that MC firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
5036 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_LS_MC_FW_ADDR is the
5037 virtual address in NOR flash.
5038
Prabhakar Kushwaha5c055082015-06-02 10:55:52 +05305039Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support:
5040-------------------------------------------
5041The Freescale Layerscape Debug Server Support supports the loading of
5042"Debug Server firmware" and triggering SP boot-rom.
5043This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting.
5044
5045- CONFIG_FSL_DEBUG_SERVER
5046 Enable the Debug Server for Layerscape SoCs.
5047
5048- CONFIG_SYS_DEBUG_SERVER_DRAM_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE
5049 Define minimum DDR size required for debug server image
5050
5051- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE_MIN
5052 Define minimum DDR size to be hided from top of the DDR memory
5053
Paul Kocialkowskif3f431a2015-07-26 18:48:15 +02005054Reproducible builds
5055-------------------
5056
5057In order to achieve reproducible builds, timestamps used in the U-Boot build
5058process have to be set to a fixed value.
5059
5060This is done using the SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH environment variable.
5061SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH is to be set on the build host's shell, not as a configuration
5062option for U-Boot or an environment variable in U-Boot.
5063
5064SOURCE_DATE_EPOCH should be set to a number of seconds since the epoch, in UTC.
5065
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005066Building the Software:
5067======================
5068
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005069Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
5070and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
5071all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
5072(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
5073recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
5074which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005075
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005076If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
5077have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
5078you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
5079Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
5080necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005081
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005082 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
5083 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005084
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05005085Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
5086 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
5087 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
5088 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
5089
5090 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
5091
5092 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
5093 be executed on computers running Windows.
5094
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005095U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
5096sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005097is done by typing:
5098
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005099 make NAME_defconfig
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005100
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005101where "NAME_defconfig" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005102rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00005103
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005104Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
5105 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
5106 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
5107 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005108 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005109
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005110 make TQM823L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005111 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005112
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005113 make TQM823L_LCD_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005114 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005115
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005116 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005117
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005118
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005119Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
5120images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005121
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005122- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
5123- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
5124- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005125
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005126By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
5127in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
5128this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
5129
51301. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
5131
5132 make O=/tmp/build distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005133 make O=/tmp/build NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005134 make O=/tmp/build all
5135
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +020051362. Set environment variable KBUILD_OUTPUT to point to the desired location:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005137
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02005138 export KBUILD_OUTPUT=/tmp/build
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005139 make distclean
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005140 make NAME_defconfig
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005141 make all
5142
Timo Ketolaadbba992014-11-06 14:39:05 +02005143Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the KBUILD_OUTPUT environment
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005144variable.
5145
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005146
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005147Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
5148for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
5149native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005150
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005151
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005152If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
5153to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
5154steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005155
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000051561. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00005157 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
5158 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000051592. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
5160 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
5161 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
51623. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
5163 your board
51643. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
5165 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +020051664. Run "make <board>_defconfig" with your new name.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000051675. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
5168 to be installed on your target system.
51696. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
5170 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005171
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005172
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005173Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
5174==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005175
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005176If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
5177or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005178provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
5179the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005180official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005181
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005182But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
5183cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005184the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
5185just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005186for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
5187select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
5188environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
5189you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005190
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005191 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005192
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005193or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005194
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005195 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005196
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005197When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
5198U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
5199setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
5200built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
5201<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
5202location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
5203variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005204
5205 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
5206 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
5207 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
5208
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005209With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
5210log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
5211during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02005212
5213
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005214See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005215
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005216
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005217Monitor Commands - Overview:
5218============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005219
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005220go - start application at address 'addr'
5221run - run commands in an environment variable
5222bootm - boot application image from memory
5223bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005224bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005225tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
5226 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
5227 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00005228tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005229rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
5230diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
5231loads - load S-Record file over serial line
5232loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
5233md - memory display
5234mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
5235nm - memory modify (constant address)
5236mw - memory write (fill)
5237cp - memory copy
5238cmp - memory compare
5239crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05005240i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005241sspi - SPI utility commands
5242base - print or set address offset
5243printenv- print environment variables
5244setenv - set environment variables
5245saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
5246protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
5247erase - erase FLASH memory
5248flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00005249nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005250bdinfo - print Board Info structure
5251iminfo - print header information for application image
5252coninfo - print console devices and informations
5253ide - IDE sub-system
5254loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00005255loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005256mtest - simple RAM test
5257icache - enable or disable instruction cache
5258dcache - enable or disable data cache
5259reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
5260echo - echo args to console
5261version - print monitor version
5262help - print online help
5263? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005264
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005265
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005266Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
5267========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005268
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005269TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005270
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005271For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005272
5273
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005274Environment Variables:
5275======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005276
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005277U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
5278can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005279
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005280Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
5281"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
5282without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
5283environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
5284working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
5285environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005286
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005287Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
5288
5289List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005290
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005291 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005292
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005293 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005294
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005295 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005296
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005297 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005298
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005299 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005300
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005301 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5302 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5303 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
5304 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
5305 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
5306 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005307 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
5308 bootm_mapsize.
5309
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005310 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00005311 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
5312 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
5313 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
5314 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
5315 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
5316 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02005317
5318 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
5319 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
5320 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
5321 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
5322 environment variable.
5323
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02005324 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
5325 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
5326 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
5327
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005328 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
5329 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
5330 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
5331 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005332
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005333 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
5334 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
5335 be automatically started (by internally calling
5336 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005337
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005338 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
5339 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
5340 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
5341 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
5342 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005343
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005344 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
5345 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00005346 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
5347 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
5348 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
5349 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
5350 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
5351 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
5352 access it during the boot procedure.
5353
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04005354 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
5355 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
5356 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
5357 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
5358 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
5359 must be accessible by the kernel.
5360
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00005361 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
5362 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
5363 defined.
5364
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00005365 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
5366 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
5367 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
5368 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
5369 it must be saved and board must be reset.
5370
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005371 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
5372 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
5373 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
5374 is usually what you want since it allows for
5375 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
5376 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005377 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005378 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
5379 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
5380 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
5381 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005382
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005383 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
5384 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
5385 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
5386 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
5387 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
5388 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005389
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005390 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005391
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005392 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
5393 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
5394 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
5395 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
5396 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
5397 boot time on your system, but requires that this
5398 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00005399
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005400 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005401
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005402 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
5403 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005404
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005405 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005406
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005407 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00005408
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005409 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005410
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005411 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005412
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005413 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005414
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005415 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005416
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00005417 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
5418 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005419
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02005420 => setenv ethact FEC
5421 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
5422 => setenv ethact SCC
5423 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005424
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01005425 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
5426 available network interfaces.
5427 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
5428
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005429 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005430 either succeed or fail without retrying.
5431 When set to "once" the network operation will
5432 fail when all the available network interfaces
5433 are tried once without success.
5434 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
5435 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005436
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01005437 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01005438
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005439 silent_linux - If set then Linux will be told to boot silently, by
Simon Glass8d51aac2013-07-16 20:10:00 -07005440 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
5441 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
5442 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
5443 is silent.
5444
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02005445 tftpsrcp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02005446 UDP source port.
5447
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02005448 tftpdstp - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02005449 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
5450
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005451 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
5452 we use the TFTP server's default block size
5453
5454 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
5455 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
5456 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
5457 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
5458 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
5459 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
5460 with unreliable TFTP servers.
5461
Albert ARIBAUD \(3ADEV\)f5fb7342015-10-12 00:02:57 +02005462 tftptimeoutcountmax - maximum count of TFTP timeouts (no
5463 unit, minimum value = 0). Defines how many timeouts
5464 can happen during a single file transfer before that
5465 transfer is aborted. The default is 10, and 0 means
5466 'no timeouts allowed'. Increasing this value may help
5467 downloads succeed with high packet loss rates, or with
5468 unreliable TFTP servers or client hardware.
5469
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01005470 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005471 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005472 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005473
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005474The following image location variables contain the location of images
5475used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
5476not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
5477variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
5478server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
5479loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
5480flash or offset in NAND flash.
5481
5482*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
Fabio Estevamaed9fed2015-04-25 18:53:10 -03005483boards currently use other variables for these purposes, and some
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005484boards use these variables for other purposes.
5485
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005486Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
5487----- --------- ----------- --------------
5488u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
5489Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
5490device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
5491ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00005492
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005493The following environment variables may be used and automatically
5494updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
5495depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005496
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005497 bootfile - see above
5498 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
5499 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
5500 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
5501 hostname - Target hostname
5502 ipaddr - see above
5503 netmask - Subnet Mask
5504 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
5505 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005506
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00005507
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005508There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005509
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005510 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
5511 as type string and/or serial number
5512 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005513
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005514These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
5515the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
5516once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005517
5518
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005519Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005520
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005521 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
5522 with the "version" command. This variable is
5523 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005524
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005525
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005526Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
5527only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005528
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005529
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005530Callback functions for environment variables:
5531---------------------------------------------
5532
5533For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005534when their values are changed. This functionality allows functions to
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005535be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
5536deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
5537effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
5538
5539The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
5540U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
5541
5542These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
5543static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
5544in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
5545associations. The list must be in the following format:
5546
5547 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
5548 list = entry[,list]
5549
5550If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
5551Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
5552
5553Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
5554with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
5555override any association in the static list. You can define
5556CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08005557".callbacks" environment variable in the default or embedded environment.
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005558
Joe Hershbergerbdf1fe42015-05-20 14:27:20 -05005559If CONFIG_REGEX is defined, the variable_name above is evaluated as a
5560regular expression. This allows multiple variables to be connected to
5561the same callback without explicitly listing them all out.
5562
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06005563
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005564Command Line Parsing:
5565=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005566
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005567There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
5568the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005569
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005570Old, simple command line parser:
5571--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005572
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005573- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
5574- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005575- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005576- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
5577 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01005578 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005579- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
5580 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005581
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005582Hush shell:
5583-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005584
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005585- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
5586 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
5587 until...do...done, ...
5588- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
5589 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
5590 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
5591 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005592
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005593General rules:
5594--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005595
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005596(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
5597 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
5598 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
5599 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005600
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005601(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005602 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005603 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
5604 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005605
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005606Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
5607=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005608
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005609Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005610such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
5611"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005612
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005613Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
5614MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
5615"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005616
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005617If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
5618in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
5619ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
5620variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005621
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005622o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
5623 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005624
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005625o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
5626 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
5627 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005628
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005629o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
5630 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005631
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005632o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
5633 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
5634 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005635
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005636o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
Joe Hershbergerbef10142015-05-04 14:55:13 -05005637 is raised. If CONFIG_NET_RANDOM_ETHADDR is defined, then in this case
5638 a random, locally-assigned MAC is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005639
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005640If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005641will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005642may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
5643The naming convention is as follows:
5644"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005645
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005646Image Formats:
5647==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005648
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01005649U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
5650images in two formats:
5651
5652New uImage format (FIT)
5653-----------------------
5654
5655Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
5656to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
5657components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
5658SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
5659
5660
5661Old uImage format
5662-----------------
5663
5664Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
5665preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
5666details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005667
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005668* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
5669 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05005670 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
5671 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
5672 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02005673* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005674 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
5675 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005676* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
5677* Load Address
5678* Entry Point
5679* Image Name
5680* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005681
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005682The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
5683and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
5684CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005685
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005686
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005687Linux Support:
5688==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005689
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005690Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
5691easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
5692U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005693
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005694U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
5695special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
5696"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
5697instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
5698serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005699
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005700- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
5701 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
5702 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005703
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005704- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
5705 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005706
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005707- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
5708 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
5709 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
5710 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
5711 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
5712 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005713
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005714
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005715Linux HOWTO:
5716============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005717
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005718Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
5719---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005720
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005721U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
5722configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
5723(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
5724Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005725
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005726But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005727
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005728Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
5729include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02005730Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
5731and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005732as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005733
Simon Glass2eb31b12014-06-11 23:29:46 -06005734Note that U-Boot now has a driver model, a unified model for drivers.
5735If you are adding a new driver, plumb it into driver model. If there
5736is no uclass available, you are encouraged to create one. See
5737doc/driver-model.
5738
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005739
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005740Configuring the Linux kernel:
5741-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005742
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005743No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
5744device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005745
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005746
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005747Building a Linux Image:
5748-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005749
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005750With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
5751not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
5752"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
5753U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
5754which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
5755100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005756
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005757Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005758
Holger Freytherab584d62014-08-04 09:26:05 +02005759 make TQM850L_defconfig
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005760 make oldconfig
5761 make dep
5762 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005763
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005764The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
5765encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
5766CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005767
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005768* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005769
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005770* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005771
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005772 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
5773 -R .note -R .comment \
5774 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005775
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005776* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005777
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005778 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005779
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005780* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005781
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005782 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
5783 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
5784 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005785
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005786
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005787The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
5788with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
5789combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
5790byte header containing information about target architecture,
5791operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
5792stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005793
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005794"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
5795print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005796
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005797In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
5798contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
5799checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005800
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005801 tools/mkimage -l image
5802 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005803
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005804The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
5805from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005806
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005807 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
5808 -n name -d data_file image
5809 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
5810 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
5811 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5812 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
5813 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
5814 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
5815 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
5816 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005817
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00005818Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
5819address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
5820kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005821
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005822- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
5823- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005824
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005825So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005826
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005827 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5828 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005829 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005830 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
5831 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5832 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5833 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5834 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5835 Load Address: 0x00000000
5836 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005837
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005838To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005839
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005840 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
5841 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5842 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5843 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5844 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5845 Load Address: 0x00000000
5846 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005847
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005848NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
5849speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
5850needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
5851need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005852
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005853 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005854 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5855 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005856 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005857 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
5858 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5859 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5860 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
5861 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
5862 Load Address: 0x00000000
5863 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005864
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005865
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005866Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
5867when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005868
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005869 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
5870 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
5871 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
5872 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5873 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
5874 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5875 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
5876 Load Address: 0x00000000
5877 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005878
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005879The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
5880option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
5881option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
5882from the image:
5883
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraf41f5b72015-01-15 02:54:40 -02005884 tools/dumpimage -i image -T type -p position data_file
5885 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file'
5886 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5887 -p ==> 'position' (starting at 0) of the 'data_file' inside the 'image'
Guilherme Maciel Ferreiraa804b5c2013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005888
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005889
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005890Installing a Linux Image:
5891-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005892
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005893To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
5894you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005895
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005896 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005897
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005898The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
5899image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
5900address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
5901specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
5902command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005903
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005904Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
5905TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005906
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005907 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005908
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005909 .......... done
5910 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005911
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005912 => loads 40100000
5913 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5914 ~>examples/image.srec
5915 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
5916 ...
5917 15989 15990 15991 15992
5918 [file transfer complete]
5919 [connected]
5920 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005921
5922
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005923You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005924this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005925corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005926
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005927 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005928
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005929 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5930 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5931 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5932 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5933 Load Address: 00000000
5934 Entry Point: 0000000c
5935 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005936
5937
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005938Boot Linux:
5939-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005940
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005941The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
5942memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
5943of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
5944parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
5945"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005946
5947
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005948 => printenv bootargs
5949 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005950
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005951 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005952
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005953 => printenv bootargs
5954 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005955
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005956 => bootm 40020000
5957 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
5958 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
5959 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5960 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
5961 Load Address: 00000000
5962 Entry Point: 0000000c
5963 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5964 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5965 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
5966 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
5967 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5968 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5969 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
5970 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005971
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005972If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005973the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
5974format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005975
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005976 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005977
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005978 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5979 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5980 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5981 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5982 Load Address: 00000000
5983 Entry Point: 0000000c
5984 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005985
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005986 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
5987 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5988 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5989 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5990 Load Address: 00000000
5991 Entry Point: 00000000
5992 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005993
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005994 => bootm 40100000 40200000
5995 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
5996 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5997 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5998 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5999 Load Address: 00000000
6000 Entry Point: 0000000c
6001 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6002 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
6003 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
6004 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
6005 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
6006 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
6007 Load Address: 00000000
6008 Entry Point: 00000000
6009 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6010 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
6011 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
6012 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
6013 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
6014 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
6015 ...
6016 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
6017 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006018
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006019 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006020
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006021Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
6022-----------
6023
6024First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
6025titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
6026following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
6027flat device tree:
6028
6029=> print oftaddr
6030oftaddr=0x300000
6031=> print oft
6032oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
6033=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
6034Speed: 1000, full duplex
6035Using TSEC0 device
6036TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
6037Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
6038Load address: 0x300000
6039Loading: #
6040done
6041Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
6042=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
6043Speed: 1000, full duplex
6044Using TSEC0 device
6045TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
6046Filename 'uImage'.
6047Load address: 0x200000
6048Loading:############
6049done
6050Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
6051=> print loadaddr
6052loadaddr=200000
6053=> print oftaddr
6054oftaddr=0x300000
6055=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
6056## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01006057 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
6058 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
6059 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006060 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01006061 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05006062 Verifying Checksum ... OK
6063 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
6064Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
6065Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
6066Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
6067[snip]
6068
6069
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006070More About U-Boot Image Types:
6071------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006072
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006073U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006074
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006075 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
6076 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
6077 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
6078 the Standalone Program.
6079 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
6080 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
6081 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
6082 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
6083 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
6084 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
6085 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
6086 being started.
6087 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
6088 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
6089 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
6090 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
6091 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
6092 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006093
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006094 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
6095 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
6096 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
6097 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
6098 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
6099 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006100
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006101 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
6102 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
6103 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00006104
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006105 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
6106 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
6107 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
6108 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00006109
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00006110Booting the Linux zImage:
6111-------------------------
6112
6113On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
6114using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
6115as the syntax of "bootm" command.
6116
Tom Rini8ac28562013-05-16 11:40:11 -04006117Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00006118kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
6119address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
6120format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
6121
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006122
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006123Standalone HOWTO:
6124=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006125
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006126One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
6127run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
6128U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006129
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006130Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006131
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006132"Hello World" Demo:
6133-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006134
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006135'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
6136application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
6137It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
6138like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006139
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006140 => loads
6141 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6142 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
6143 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6144 [file transfer complete]
6145 [connected]
6146 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006147
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006148 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
6149 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6150 Hello World
6151 argc = 7
6152 argv[0] = "40004"
6153 argv[1] = "Hello"
6154 argv[2] = "World!"
6155 argv[3] = "This"
6156 argv[4] = "is"
6157 argv[5] = "a"
6158 argv[6] = "test."
6159 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
6160 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006162 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006163
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006164Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
6165handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
6166Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
6167The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
6168character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
6169controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006170
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006171 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
6172 b - enable interrupts and start timer
6173 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
6174 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006175
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006176 => loads
6177 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
6178 ~>examples/timer.srec
6179 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
6180 [file transfer complete]
6181 [connected]
6182 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006183
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006184 => go 40004
6185 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
6186 TIMERS=0xfff00980
6187 Using timer 1
6188 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006189
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006190Hit 'b':
6191 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
6192 Enabling timer
6193Hit '?':
6194 [q, b, e, ?] ........
6195 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
6196Hit '?':
6197 [q, b, e, ?] .
6198 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
6199Hit '?':
6200 [q, b, e, ?] .
6201 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
6202Hit '?':
6203 [q, b, e, ?] .
6204 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
6205Hit 'e':
6206 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
6207Hit 'q':
6208 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006209
6210
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006211Minicom warning:
6212================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006213
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006214Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
6215"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
6216consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
6217Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
6218especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00006219use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
6220http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
6221for help with kermit.
6222
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00006223
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006224Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
6225configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006226
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006227 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
6228 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
6229 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006230
6231
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006232NetBSD Notes:
6233=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006234
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006235Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
6236(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006237
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006238Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
6239NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
6240need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
6241Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
6242attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
6243missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006244
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006245 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
6246 # mkdir powerpc
6247 # ln -s powerpc machine
6248 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
6249 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006250
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006251Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
6252and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006254Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
6255stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
6256proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
6257tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00006258meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006259
6260
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006261Implementation Internals:
6262=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006263
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006264The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
6265implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
6266inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
6267hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006268
6269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006270Initial Stack, Global Data:
6271---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006273The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
6274starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
6275system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
6276This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
6277is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
6278at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
6279options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
6280models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
6281MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
6282locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006283
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006284 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006285 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006286
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006287 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
6288 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
6289 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
6290 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006291
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006292 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
6293 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
6294 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
6295 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
6296 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006297 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006298 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
6299 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006300
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006301 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
6302 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006303 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006304 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
6305 board designers haven't used it for something that would
6306 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
6307 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006308
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006309 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006310 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
6311 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02006312 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006313 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
6314 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
6315 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
6316 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
6317 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006318
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006319 -Chris Hallinan
6320 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00006321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006322It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
6323code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006324
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006325* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
6326 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006327
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006328* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitly initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006329 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
6330 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006331
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006332* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
6333 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006334
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006335Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006336normal global data to share information between the code. But it
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006337turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
6338simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
6339functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
6340functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
6341the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
6342place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
6343reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006344
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006345When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
6346relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
6347GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006348
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006349For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
6350 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006351 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006352 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
6353 R5-R10: parameter passing
6354 R13: small data area pointer
6355 R30: GOT pointer
6356 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006357
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01006358 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
6359 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
6360 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006361
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01006362 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006363
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006364 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
6365 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
6366 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
6367 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
6368 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
6369 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006370
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006371On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006372 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
6373
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00006374 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05006375
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006376On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006377
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006378 R0: function argument word/integer result
6379 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006380 R9: platform specific
6381 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006382 R11: argument (frame) pointer
6383 R12: temporary workspace
6384 R13: stack pointer
6385 R14: link register
6386 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006387
Jeroen Hofstee12eba1b2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02006388 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
6389
6390 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006391
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08006392On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
6393 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
6394
6395 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
6396
6397 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
6398 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
6399
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00006400On NDS32, the following registers are used:
6401
6402 R0-R1: argument/return
6403 R2-R5: argument
6404 R15: temporary register for assembler
6405 R16: trampoline register
6406 R28: frame pointer (FP)
6407 R29: global pointer (GP)
6408 R30: link register (LP)
6409 R31: stack pointer (SP)
6410 PC: program counter (PC)
6411
6412 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
6413
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02006414NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
6415or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006416
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006417Memory Management:
6418------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006419
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006420U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
6421MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006422
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006423The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
6424controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
6425memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
6426physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006427
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006428U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
6429TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
6430booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
6431to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02006432memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006433configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
6434Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006435
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006436Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
6437of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006438
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006439So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
6440this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006441
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006442 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
6443 :
6444 0x0000 1FFF
6445 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
6446 :
6447 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006448
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006449 :
6450 :
6451 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
6452 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
6453 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
6454 :
6455 0x00FD FFFF
6456 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
6457 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
6458 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
6459 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006460
6461
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006462System Initialization:
6463----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006464
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006465In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02006466(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006467configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the on board Flash memory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006468To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
6469To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
6470initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
6471which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
6472part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
6473the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006474
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006475Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
6476preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
6477(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
6478on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
6479programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
6480simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
6481banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006482
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006483When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
6484different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
6485bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
64860x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
6487contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006488
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006489Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
6490and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
6491Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
6492pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006493
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006494Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
6495until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
6496running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
6497new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006498
6499
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006500U-Boot Porting Guide:
6501----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006502
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006503[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
6504list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006505
6506
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006507int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006508{
6509 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006510
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006511 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
6512 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006513
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006514 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006515 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006516 return 0;
6517 }
6518
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006519 Download latest U-Boot source;
6520
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006521 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006522
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006523 if (clueless)
6524 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006525
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006526 while (learning) {
6527 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006528 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
6529 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006530 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006531 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006532 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006533
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006534 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
6535 Buy a BDI3000;
6536 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006537 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006538
6539 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
6540 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
6541 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
6542 } else {
6543 Create your own board support subdirectory;
6544 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006545 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006546 Edit new board/<myboard> files
6547 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006548
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04006549 while (!accepted) {
6550 while (!running) {
6551 do {
6552 Add / modify source code;
6553 } until (compiles);
6554 Debug;
6555 if (clueless)
6556 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
6557 }
6558 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
6559 if (reasonable critiques)
6560 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
6561 else
6562 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006563 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006564
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006565 return 0;
6566}
6567
6568void no_more_time (int sig)
6569{
6570 hire_a_guru();
6571}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006572
6573
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006574Coding Standards:
6575-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006576
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006577All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006578coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006579"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006580
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006581Source files originating from a different project (for example the
6582MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
Jeremiah Mahlerb445bbb2015-01-04 18:56:50 -08006583reformatted to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02006584sources.
6585
6586Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
6587Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
6588in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006589
6590Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
6591- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006592- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006593- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006594- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006595- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
6596
6597Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
6598with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006599
6600
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006601Submitting Patches:
6602-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006603
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006604Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
6605establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
6606may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006607
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02006608Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006609
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006610Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
6611see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
6612
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006613When you send a patch, please include the following information with
6614it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006615
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006616* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
6617 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
6618 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006619
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006620* For new features: a description of the feature and your
6621 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006622
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006623* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
6624
6625* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
6626
Albert ARIBAUD27af9302013-09-11 15:52:51 +02006627* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
6628 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006629
6630* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
6631 document these in the README file.
6632
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006633* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
6634 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006635 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006636 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
6637 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006638
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006639 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
6640 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
6641 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006642
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006643 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
6644 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
6645 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
6646 affected files).
6647
6648 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
6649 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006650
6651* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
6652 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
6653
6654* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
6655 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
6656
6657
6658Notes:
6659
6660* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
6661 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
6662 for any of the boards.
6663
6664* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
6665 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
6666 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
6667
6668* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
6669 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
6670 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
6671 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
6672 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
6673 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00006674
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006675* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
6676 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
6677 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
6678 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.